1  /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2  /*
3   * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4   *
5   * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6   * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7   * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8   * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9   * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10   * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11   */
12  
13  #ifndef MAC80211_H
14  #define MAC80211_H
15  
16  #include <linux/bug.h>
17  #include <linux/kernel.h>
18  #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19  #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20  #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21  #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22  #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23  #include <net/codel.h>
24  #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25  #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26  
27  /**
28   * DOC: Introduction
29   *
30   * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31   * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32   * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33   * drivers.
34   */
35  
36  /**
37   * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38   *
39   * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40   * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41   * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42   * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43   * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44   * tasklet function.
45   *
46   * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47   *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48   */
49  
50  /**
51   * DOC: Warning
52   *
53   * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54   * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55   */
56  
57  /**
58   * DOC: Frame format
59   *
60   * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61   * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62   * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63   * hardware.
64   *
65   * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66   *
67   * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68   * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69   *
70   * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71   * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72   */
73  
74  /**
75   * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76   *
77   * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78   * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79   * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80   * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81   *
82   * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83   * suspend.
84   *
85   * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86   *
87   */
88  
89  /**
90   * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91   *
92   * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93   * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94   * different stations/interfaces.
95   *
96   * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97   * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98   * handler.
99   *
100   * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101   * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102   * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103   *
104   * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105   * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106   *
107   * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108   * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109   * driver op.
110   * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112   * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113   *
114   * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115   * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116   * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117   * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118   * ieee80211_return_txq().
119   *
120   * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121   * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122   * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123   * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124   * .release_buffered_frames().
125   * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126   * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127   * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128   */
129  
130  /**
131   * DOC: HW timestamping
132   *
133   * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134   * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135   *
136   * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137   * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138   * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139   * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140   *
141   * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142   * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143   * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144   * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145   */
146  struct device;
147  
148  /**
149   * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150   *
151   * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152   * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153   */
154  enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155  	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156  	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157  };
158  
159  #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160  
161  /**
162   * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163   * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164   * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165   * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166   * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167   */
168  enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169  	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170  	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171  	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172  	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173  };
174  
175  /**
176   * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177   *
178   * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179   * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180   *
181   * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182   * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183   *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184   * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185   * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186   * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187   * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188   * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189   * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190   */
191  struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192  	u16 txop;
193  	u16 cw_min;
194  	u16 cw_max;
195  	u8 aifs;
196  	bool acm;
197  	bool uapsd;
198  	bool mu_edca;
199  	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200  };
201  
202  struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203  	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204  	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205  	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206  	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207  };
208  
209  /**
210   * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215   *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217   */
218  enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224  };
225  
226  /**
227   * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228   *
229   * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230   * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231   *
232   * @def: the channel definition
233   * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234   * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235   *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236   * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237   *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238   *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239   * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241   *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242   */
243  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244  	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245  	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246  
247  	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248  
249  	bool radar_enabled;
250  
251  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252  };
253  
254  /**
255   * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256   * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257   *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258   *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259   * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260   *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261   *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262   *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263   *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264   *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265   *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266   *      for changes/removal.)
267   */
268  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269  	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270  	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271  };
272  
273  /**
274   * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275   *
276   * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277   * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278   * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279   * done.
280   *
281   * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282   * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283   * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284   * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285   */
286  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291  };
292  
293  /**
294   * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295   *
296   * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297   * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298   *
299   * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300   *	also implies a change in the AID.
301   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304   * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305   * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307   * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308   *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310   *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312   *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313   * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314   * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315   * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316   * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317   *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318   * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319   * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320   * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321   * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322   * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323   * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324   *	changed
325   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326   *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327   * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328   *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329   *	context had been assigned.
330   * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331   * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332   * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333   *	keep alive) changed.
334   * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335   * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336   *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337   * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338   * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339   * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340   * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341   * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342   *	status changed.
343   * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344   */
345  enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346  	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350  	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351  	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353  	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356  	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357  	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358  	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359  	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360  	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361  	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362  	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363  	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364  	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365  	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367  	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368  	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369  	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370  	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371  	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372  	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373  	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374  	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375  	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376  	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377  	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378  	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379  
380  	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381  };
382  
383  /*
384   * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385   * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386   * filtering will be disabled.
387   */
388  #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389  
390  /**
391   * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392   * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393   * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394   * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395   * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396   *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397   *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398   */
399  enum ieee80211_event_type {
400  	RSSI_EVENT,
401  	MLME_EVENT,
402  	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403  	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404  };
405  
406  /**
407   * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408   * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409   * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410   */
411  enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412  	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413  	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414  };
415  
416  /**
417   * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418   * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419   */
420  struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421  	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422  };
423  
424  /**
425   * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426   * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427   * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428   * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429   * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430   */
431  enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432  	AUTH_EVENT,
433  	ASSOC_EVENT,
434  	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435  	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436  };
437  
438  /**
439   * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440   * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441   * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442   * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443   */
444  enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445  	MLME_SUCCESS,
446  	MLME_DENIED,
447  	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448  };
449  
450  /**
451   * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452   * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453   * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454   * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455   */
456  struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457  	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458  	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459  	u16 reason;
460  };
461  
462  /**
463   * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464   * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465   * @tid: the tid
466   * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467   */
468  struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470  	u16 tid;
471  	u16 ssn;
472  };
473  
474  /**
475   * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476   * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477   * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478   * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479   * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480   * @u:union holding the fields above
481   */
482  struct ieee80211_event {
483  	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484  	union {
485  		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486  		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487  		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488  	} u;
489  };
490  
491  /**
492   * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493   *
494   * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495   *
496   * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497   * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498   */
499  struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500  	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501  	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502  };
503  
504  /**
505   * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506   *
507   * @lci: LCI subelement content
508   * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509   * @lci_len: LCI data length
510   * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511   */
512  struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513  	const u8 *lci;
514  	const u8 *civicloc;
515  	size_t lci_len;
516  	size_t civicloc_len;
517  };
518  
519  /**
520   * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521   * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522   *
523   * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524   * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525   */
526  struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527  	u32 min_interval;
528  	u32 max_interval;
529  };
530  
531  /**
532   * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533   *
534   * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535   * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536   *
537   * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538   * @addr: (link) address used locally
539   * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540   * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541   * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542   * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543   *	ACK, BACK or both
544   * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545   * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546   * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547   * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548   *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549   * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550   *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551   * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552   * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553   * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554   * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555   * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556   * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557   *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558   *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559   * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560   *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561   *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562   *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563   *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564   *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565   * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566   *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567   *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568   * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569   *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570   *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571   *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572   *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573   *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574   *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575   * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576   * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577   * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578   *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579   *	the current band.
580   * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581   * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582   * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583   * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584   * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585   *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586   * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587   * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588   *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589   *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590   *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591   * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592   *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593   *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594   *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
595   * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596   *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597   *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598   * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599   * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600   * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601   * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602   * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
603   * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604   *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605   *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607   *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609   * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610   * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611   *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612   *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613   * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614   *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615   *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616   *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617   * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618   *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619   *	station.
620   * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621   *	responder functionality.
622   * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623   * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624   * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625   * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626   * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627   * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628   *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
629   * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630   *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631   * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632   *	connected to (STA)
633   * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634   * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635   * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636   * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637   *	interval.
638   * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639   *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640   * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641   * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642   * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643   * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644   * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645   * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646   * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
647   *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
648   *	for read access.
649   * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650   * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651   * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652   *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653   *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654   *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655   *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656   * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
657   *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
658   *	for read access.
659   * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
660   * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
661   * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
662   * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
663   * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664   *	beamformer
665   * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
666   *	beamformee
667   * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668   *	beamformer
669   * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
670   *	beamformee
671   * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672   *	beamformer
673   * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
674   *	beamformee
675   * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
676   *	beamformer
677   * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
678   *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
679   *	bandwidth
680   * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681   *	beamformer
682   * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
683   *	beamformee
684   * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
685   *	beamformer
686   */
687  struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
688  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
689  
690  	const u8 *bssid;
691  	unsigned int link_id;
692  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
693  	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
694  	bool uora_exists;
695  	u8 uora_ocw_range;
696  	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
697  	bool he_support;
698  	bool twt_requester;
699  	bool twt_responder;
700  	bool twt_protected;
701  	bool twt_broadcast;
702  	/* erp related data */
703  	bool use_cts_prot;
704  	bool use_short_preamble;
705  	bool use_short_slot;
706  	bool enable_beacon;
707  	u8 dtim_period;
708  	u16 beacon_int;
709  	u16 assoc_capability;
710  	u64 sync_tsf;
711  	u32 sync_device_ts;
712  	u8 sync_dtim_count;
713  	u32 basic_rates;
714  	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
715  	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
716  	u16 ht_operation_mode;
717  	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
718  	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
719  	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
720  	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
721  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
722  	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
723  	bool qos;
724  	bool hidden_ssid;
725  	int txpower;
726  	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
727  	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
728  	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
729  	u16 max_idle_period;
730  	bool protected_keep_alive;
731  	bool ftm_responder;
732  	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
733  	/* Multiple BSSID data */
734  	bool nontransmitted;
735  	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
736  	u8 bssid_index;
737  	u8 bssid_indicator;
738  	bool ema_ap;
739  	u8 profile_periodicity;
740  	struct {
741  		u32 params;
742  		u16 nss_set;
743  	} he_oper;
744  	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
745  	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
746  	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
747  	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
748  	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
749  	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
750  	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
751  	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
752  	u8 pwr_reduction;
753  	bool eht_support;
754  	u16 eht_puncturing;
755  
756  	bool csa_active;
757  	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
758  
759  	bool mu_mimo_owner;
760  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
761  
762  	bool color_change_active;
763  	u8 color_change_color;
764  
765  	bool ht_ldpc;
766  	bool vht_ldpc;
767  	bool he_ldpc;
768  	bool vht_su_beamformer;
769  	bool vht_su_beamformee;
770  	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
771  	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
772  	bool he_su_beamformer;
773  	bool he_su_beamformee;
774  	bool he_mu_beamformer;
775  	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
776  	bool eht_su_beamformer;
777  	bool eht_su_beamformee;
778  	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
779  };
780  
781  /**
782   * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
783   *
784   * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
785   *
786   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
787   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
788   *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
789   *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
790   *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
791   *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
792   *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
793   *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
794   *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
795   *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
796   *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
797   *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
798   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
799   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
800   *	station
801   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
802   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
803   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
804   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
805   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
806   *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
807   *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
808   *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
809   *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
810   *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
811   *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
812   *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
813   *	hardware queue.
814   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
815   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
816   * 	is for the whole aggregation.
817   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
818   * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
819   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
820   *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
821   *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
822   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
823   *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
824   *	off-channel operation.
825   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
826   *	(header conversion)
827   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
828   *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
829   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
830   *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
831   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
832   *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
833   *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
834   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
835   *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
836   *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
837   *	queue gets full.
838   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
839   *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
840   *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
841   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
842   *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
843   *	should kick the MLME state machine.
844   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
845   *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
846   *	status to user space)
847   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
848   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
849   *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
850   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
851   *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
852   *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
853   *	handled properly by the device.
854   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
855   *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
856   *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
857   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
858   *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
859   *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
860   * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
861   *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
862   *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
863   *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
864   *	PS-Poll responses.
865   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
866   *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
867   *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
868   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
869   *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
870   *	monitor injection).
871   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
872   *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
873   *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
874   *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
875   *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
876   *
877   * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
878   *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
879   */
880  enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
881  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
882  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
883  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
884  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
885  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
886  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
887  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
888  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
889  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
890  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
891  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
892  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
893  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
894  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
895  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
896  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
897  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
898  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
899  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
900  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
901  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
902  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
903  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
904  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
905  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
906  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
907  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
908  	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
909  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
910  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
911  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
912  };
913  
914  #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
915  
916  #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
917  
918  /**
919   * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
920   *
921   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
922   *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
923   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
924   *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
925   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
926   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
927   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
928   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
929   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
930   *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
931   *	it can be sent out.
932   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
933   *	has already been assigned to this frame.
934   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
935   *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
936   *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
937   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
938   *	for sequence number assignment
939   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
940   *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
941   *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
942   *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
943   *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
944   *	it's intended for an MLD.
945   *
946   * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
947   */
948  enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
949  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
950  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
951  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
952  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
953  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
954  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
955  	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
956  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
957  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
958  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
959  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
960  };
961  
962  #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
963  #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
964  	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
965  			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
966  
967  /**
968   * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
969   *
970   * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
971   *
972   * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
973   */
974  enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
975  	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
976  };
977  
978  /*
979   * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
980   * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
981   */
982  #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
983  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
984  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
985  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
986  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
987  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
988  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
989  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
990  
991  /**
992   * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
993   *	Rate Control algorithm.
994   *
995   * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
996   * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
997   *
998   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
999   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1000   *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1001   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1002   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1003   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1004   *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1005   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1006   *	Greenfield mode.
1007   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1008   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1009   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1010   *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1011   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1012   *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1013   *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1014   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1015   */
1016  enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1017  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1018  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1019  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1020  
1021  	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1022  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1023  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1024  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1025  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1026  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1027  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1028  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1029  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1030  };
1031  
1032  
1033  /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1034  #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1035  
1036  /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1037  #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1038  
1039  /* maximum number of rate stages */
1040  #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1041  
1042  /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1043  #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1044  
1045  /**
1046   * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1047   *
1048   * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1049   * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1050   * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1051   *
1052   * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1053   * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1054   *
1055   * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1056   * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1057   *
1058   * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1059   * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1060   * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1061   * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1062   * information::
1063   *
1064   *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1065   *
1066   * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1067   * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1068   * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1069   * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1070   * information should then contain::
1071   *
1072   *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1073   *
1074   * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1075   * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1076   */
1077  struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1078  	s8 idx;
1079  	u16 count:5,
1080  	    flags:11;
1081  } __packed;
1082  
1083  #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1084  
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1085  static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1086  					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1087  {
1088  	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1089  	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1090  	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1091  }
1092  
1093  static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1094  ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1095  {
1096  	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1097  }
1098  
1099  static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1100  ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1101  {
1102  	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1103  }
1104  
1105  /**
1106   * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1107   *
1108   * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1109   *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1110   *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1111   *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1112   *
1113   * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1114   * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1115   *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1116   *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1117   * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1118   * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1119   * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1120   * @control: union part for control data
1121   * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1122   * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1123   * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1124   * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1125   * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1126   * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1127   * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1128   * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1129   * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1130   * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1131   * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1132   * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1133   * @pad: padding
1134   * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1135   * @status: union part for status data
1136   * @status.rates: attempted rates
1137   * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1138   * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1139   * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1140   * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1141   * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1142   *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1143   * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1144   * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1145   * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1146   * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1147   * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1148   * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1149   * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1150   * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1151   * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1152   * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1153   */
1154  struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1155  	/* common information */
1156  	u32 flags;
1157  	u32 band:3,
1158  	    ack_frame_id:13,
1159  	    hw_queue:4,
1160  	    tx_time_est:10;
1161  	/* 2 free bits */
1162  
1163  	union {
1164  		struct {
1165  			union {
1166  				/* rate control */
1167  				struct {
1168  					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1169  						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1170  					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1171  					u8 use_rts:1;
1172  					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1173  					u8 short_preamble:1;
1174  					u8 skip_table:1;
1175  					/* 2 bytes free */
1176  				};
1177  				/* only needed before rate control */
1178  				unsigned long jiffies;
1179  			};
1180  			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1181  			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1182  			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1183  			u32 flags;
1184  			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1185  		} control;
1186  		struct {
1187  			u64 cookie;
1188  		} ack;
1189  		struct {
1190  			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1191  			s32 ack_signal;
1192  			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1193  			u8 ampdu_len;
1194  			u8 antenna;
1195  			u8 pad;
1196  			u16 tx_time;
1197  			u8 flags;
1198  			u8 pad2;
1199  			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1200  		} status;
1201  		struct {
1202  			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1203  				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1204  			u8 pad[4];
1205  
1206  			void *rate_driver_data[
1207  				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1208  		};
1209  		void *driver_data[
1210  			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1211  	};
1212  };
1213  
1214  static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1215  ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1216  {
1217  	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1218  	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1219  	 */
1220  	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1221  	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1222  }
1223  
1224  static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1225  ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1226  {
1227  	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1228  }
1229  
1230  /***
1231   * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1232   *
1233   * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1234   * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1235   *
1236   * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1237   * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1238   * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1239   * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1240   * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1241   */
1242  struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1243  	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1244  	u8 try_count;
1245  	u8 tx_power_idx;
1246  };
1247  
1248  /**
1249   * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1250   *
1251   * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1252   * @info: Basic tx status information
1253   * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1254   * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1255   * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1256   * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1257   * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1258   *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1259   *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1260   */
1261  struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1262  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1263  	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1264  	struct sk_buff *skb;
1265  	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1266  	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1267  	u8 n_rates;
1268  
1269  	struct list_head *free_list;
1270  };
1271  
1272  /**
1273   * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1274   *
1275   * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1276   * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1277   * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1278   *
1279   * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1280   * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1281   * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1282   * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1283   */
1284  struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1285  	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1286  	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1287  	const u8 *common_ies;
1288  	size_t common_ie_len;
1289  };
1290  
1291  
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1292  static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1293  {
1294  	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1295  }
1296  
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1297  static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1298  {
1299  	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1300  }
1301  
1302  /**
1303   * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1304   *
1305   * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1306   *
1307   * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1308   * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1309   * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1310   * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1311   *
1312   * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1313   *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1314   *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1315   */
1316  static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1317  ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1318  {
1319  	int i;
1320  
1321  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1322  		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1323  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1324  		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1325  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1326  	/* clear the rate counts */
1327  	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1328  		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1329  	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1330  }
1331  
1332  
1333  /**
1334   * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1335   *
1336   * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1337   * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1338   *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1339   * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1340   * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1341   *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1342   * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1343   *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1344   *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1345   * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1346   *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1347   *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1348   *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1349   * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1350   *	de-duplication by itself.
1351   * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1352   *	the frame.
1353   * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1354   *	the frame.
1355   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1356   *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1357   *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1358   *	merging.
1359   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1360   *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1361   *	(including FCS) was received.
1362   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1363   *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1364   * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1365   *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1366   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1367   *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1368   *	each A-MPDU
1369   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1370   *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1371   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1372   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1373   *	on this subframe
1374   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1375   *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1376   * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1377   *	done by the hardware
1378   * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1379   *	processing it in any regular way.
1380   *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1381   *	them for sniffing purposes.
1382   * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1383   *	monitor interfaces.
1384   *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1385   *	them for sniffing purposes.
1386   * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1387   *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1388   *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1389   *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1390   *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1391   *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1392   *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1393   *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1394   *	interleaved with other frames.
1395   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1396   *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1397   *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1398   *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1399   *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1400   *	in the skb.
1401   * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1402   *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1403   *	the first subframe.
1404   * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1405   *	be done in the hardware.
1406   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1407   *	frame
1408   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1409   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1410   *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1411   *
1412   *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1413   *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1414   *	 - DATA3_CODING
1415   *	 - DATA5_GI
1416   *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1417   *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1418   *	 - DATA3_STBC
1419   *
1420   *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1421   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1422   *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1423   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1424   * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1425   *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1426   *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1427   *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1428   * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1429   *	hardware or driver)
1430   */
1431  enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1432  	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1433  	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1434  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1435  	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1436  	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1437  	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1438  	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1439  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1440  	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1441  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1442  	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1443  	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1444  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1445  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1446  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1447  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1448  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1449  	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1450  	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1451  	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1452  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1453  	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1454  	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1455  	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1456  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1457  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1458  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1459  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1460  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1461  	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1462  	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1463  };
1464  
1465  /**
1466   * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1467   *
1468   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1469   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1470   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1471   *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1472   *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1473   *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1474   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1475   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1476   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1477   */
1478  enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1479  	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1480  	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1481  	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1482  	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1483  	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1484  	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1485  };
1486  
1487  #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1488  
1489  enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1490  	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1491  	RX_ENC_HT,
1492  	RX_ENC_VHT,
1493  	RX_ENC_HE,
1494  	RX_ENC_EHT,
1495  };
1496  
1497  /**
1498   * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1499   *
1500   * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1501   * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1502   * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1503   *
1504   * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1505   * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1506   * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1507   *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1508   * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1509   *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1510   *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1511   * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1512   *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1513   * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1514   * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1515   *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1516   *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1517   * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1518   * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1519   *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1520   *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1521   * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1522   *	values were filled.
1523   * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1524   *	support dB or unspecified units)
1525   * @antenna: antenna used
1526   * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1527   *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1528   * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1529   * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1530   * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1531   * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1532   * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1533   * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1534   * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1535   * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1536   * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1537   * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1538   * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1539   * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1540   * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1541   *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1542   * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1543   * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1544   * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1545   *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1546   * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1547   *	@link_valid.
1548   */
1549  struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1550  	u64 mactime;
1551  	union {
1552  		u64 boottime_ns;
1553  		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1554  	};
1555  	u32 device_timestamp;
1556  	u32 ampdu_reference;
1557  	u32 flag;
1558  	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1559  	u8 enc_flags;
1560  	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1561  	union {
1562  		struct {
1563  			u8 he_ru:3;
1564  			u8 he_gi:2;
1565  			u8 he_dcm:1;
1566  		};
1567  		struct {
1568  			u8 ru:4;
1569  			u8 gi:2;
1570  		} eht;
1571  	};
1572  	u8 rate_idx;
1573  	u8 nss;
1574  	u8 rx_flags;
1575  	u8 band;
1576  	u8 antenna;
1577  	s8 signal;
1578  	u8 chains;
1579  	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1580  	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1581  	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1582  	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1583  };
1584  
1585  static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1586  ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1587  {
1588  	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1589  	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1590  }
1591  
1592  /**
1593   * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1594   *
1595   * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1596   *
1597   * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1598   *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1599   *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1600   * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1601   *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1602   *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1603   *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1604   *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1605   *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1606   *	for more.
1607   * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1608   *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1609   *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1610   *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1611   *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1612   * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1613   *	operating channel.
1614   */
1615  enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1616  	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1617  	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1618  	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1619  	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1620  };
1621  
1622  
1623  /**
1624   * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1625   *
1626   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1627   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1628   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1629   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1630   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1631   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1632   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1633   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1634   *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1635   *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1636   */
1637  enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1638  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1639  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1640  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1641  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1642  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1643  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1644  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1645  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1646  };
1647  
1648  /**
1649   * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1650   *
1651   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1652   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1653   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1654   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1655   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1656   */
1657  enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1658  	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1659  	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1660  	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1661  	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1662  
1663  	/* keep last */
1664  	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1665  };
1666  
1667  /**
1668   * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1669   *
1670   * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1671   *
1672   * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1673   *
1674   * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1675   * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1676   *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1677   *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1678   * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1679   *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1680   *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1681   *
1682   * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1683   *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1684   *
1685   * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1686   * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1687   *
1688   * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1689   *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1690   *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1691   * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1692   *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1693   *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1694   *
1695   * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1696   *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1697   *	configured for an HT channel.
1698   *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1699   *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1700   */
1701  struct ieee80211_conf {
1702  	u32 flags;
1703  	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1704  
1705  	u16 listen_interval;
1706  	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1707  
1708  	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1709  
1710  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1711  	bool radar_enabled;
1712  	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1713  };
1714  
1715  /**
1716   * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1717   *
1718   * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1719   * operation.
1720   *
1721   * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1722   *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1723   *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1724   *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1725   * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1726   *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1727   * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1728   *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1729   * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1730   * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1731   * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1732    *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1733    *	channel, expressed in TU.
1734   */
1735  struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1736  	u64 timestamp;
1737  	u32 device_timestamp;
1738  	bool block_tx;
1739  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1740  	u8 count;
1741  	u32 delay;
1742  };
1743  
1744  /**
1745   * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1746   *
1747   * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1748   *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1749   * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1750   *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1751   *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1752   *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1753   * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1754   *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1755   *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1756   *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1757   * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1758   *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1759   *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1760   * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of
1761   *	SMPS mode via debugfs.
1762   */
1763  enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1764  	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1765  	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1766  	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1767  	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1768  	IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE	= BIT(4),
1769  };
1770  
1771  
1772  /**
1773   * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1774   *
1775   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1776   *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1777   *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1778   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1779   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1780   *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1781   *	mac80211.
1782   */
1783  
1784  enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1785  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1786  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1787  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1788  };
1789  
1790  /**
1791   * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1792   * @assoc: association status
1793   * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1794   * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1795   * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1796   *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1797   * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1798   * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1799   * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1800   *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1801   * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1802   *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1803   *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1804   *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1805   * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1806   *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1807   *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1808   * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1809   * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1810   * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1811   * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1812   *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1813   *	your driver/device needs to do.
1814   * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1815   *	(station mode only)
1816   */
1817  struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1818  	/* association related data */
1819  	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1820  	bool ibss_creator;
1821  	bool ps;
1822  	u16 aid;
1823  	u16 eml_cap;
1824  	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1825  
1826  	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1827  	int arp_addr_cnt;
1828  	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1829  	size_t ssid_len;
1830  	bool s1g;
1831  	bool idle;
1832  	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1833  };
1834  
1835  /**
1836   * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1837   *
1838   * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1839   * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1840   *
1841   * @type: type of this virtual interface
1842   * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1843   * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1844   *	or the BSS we're associated to
1845   * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1846   *	indexed by link ID
1847   * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1848   * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1849   *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1850   *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1851   * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1852   *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1853   * @addr: address of this interface
1854   * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1855   *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1856   * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1857   *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1858   *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1859   *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1860   * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1861   *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1862   *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1863   *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1864   * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1865   *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1866   *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1867   *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1868   *	restrictions.
1869   * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1870   * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1871   * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1872   *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1873   *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1874   * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1875   *	interface.
1876   * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1877   *	for this interface.
1878   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1879   *	sizeof(void \*).
1880   * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1881   * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1882   *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1883   * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1884   */
1885  struct ieee80211_vif {
1886  	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1887  	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1888  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1889  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1890  	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1891  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1892  	bool p2p;
1893  
1894  	u8 cab_queue;
1895  	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1896  
1897  	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1898  
1899  	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1900  	u32 driver_flags;
1901  	u32 offload_flags;
1902  
1903  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1904  	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1905  #endif
1906  
1907  	bool probe_req_reg;
1908  	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1909  
1910  	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1911  
1912  	/* must be last */
1913  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1914  };
1915  
1916  /**
1917   * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1918   * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1919   * Return: the usable link bitmap
1920   */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1921  static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1922  {
1923  	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1924  }
1925  
1926  /**
1927   * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1928   * @vif: the vif
1929   * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1930   */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1931  static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1932  {
1933  	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1934  	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1935  }
1936  
1937  #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1938  	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1939  		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1940  		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1941  		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1942  
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1943  static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1944  {
1945  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1946  	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1947  #endif
1948  	return false;
1949  }
1950  
1951  /**
1952   * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1953   * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1954   *
1955   * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1956   * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1957   *
1958   * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1959   * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1960   * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1961   */
1962  struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1963  
1964  /**
1965   * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1966   * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1967   *
1968   * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1969   * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1970   * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1971   */
1972  struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1973  
1974  /**
1975   * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1976   * @vif: the interface to check
1977   */
lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1978  static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1979  {
1980  	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1981  }
1982  
1983  #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1984  	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1985  				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1986  
1987  #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1988  	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1989  			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1990  
1991  /**
1992   * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1993   *
1994   * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1995   * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1996   *
1997   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1998   *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1999   *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2000   *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2001   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2002   *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2003   *	generation in software.
2004   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2005   *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2006   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2007   *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2008   *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2009   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2010   *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2011   *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2012   *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2013   *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2014   *	MIC.
2015   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2016   *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2017   *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2018   *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2019   *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2020   *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2021   *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2022   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2023   *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2024   *	only for management frames (MFP).
2025   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2026   *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2027   *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2028   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2029   *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2030   *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2031   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2032   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2033   *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2034   *	generation only
2035   */
2036  enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2037  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2038  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2039  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2040  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2041  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2042  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2043  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2044  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2045  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2046  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2047  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2048  };
2049  
2050  /**
2051   * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2052   *
2053   * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2054   * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2055   *
2056   * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2057   *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2058   *	encrypted in hardware.
2059   * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2060   * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2061   *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2062   * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2063   * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2064   * @keylen: key material length
2065   * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2066   * 	data block:
2067   * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2068   * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2069   * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2070   * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2071   * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2072   * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2073   */
2074  struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2075  	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2076  	u32 cipher;
2077  	u8 icv_len;
2078  	u8 iv_len;
2079  	u8 hw_key_idx;
2080  	s8 keyidx;
2081  	u16 flags;
2082  	s8 link_id;
2083  	u8 keylen;
2084  	u8 key[];
2085  };
2086  
2087  #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2088  
2089  #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2090  #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2091  
2092  /**
2093   * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2094   *
2095   * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2096   * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2097   *	reverse order than in packet)
2098   * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2099   *	reverse order than in packet)
2100   * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2101   *	reverse order than in packet)
2102   * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2103   *	reverse order than in packet)
2104   * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2105   */
2106  struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2107  	union {
2108  		struct {
2109  			u32 iv32;
2110  			u16 iv16;
2111  		} tkip;
2112  		struct {
2113  			u8 pn[6];
2114  		} ccmp;
2115  		struct {
2116  			u8 pn[6];
2117  		} aes_cmac;
2118  		struct {
2119  			u8 pn[6];
2120  		} aes_gmac;
2121  		struct {
2122  			u8 pn[6];
2123  		} gcmp;
2124  		struct {
2125  			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2126  			u8 seq_len;
2127  		} hw;
2128  	};
2129  };
2130  
2131  /**
2132   * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2133   *
2134   * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2135   * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2136   *
2137   * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2138   * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2139   */
2140  enum set_key_cmd {
2141  	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2142  };
2143  
2144  /**
2145   * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2146   *
2147   * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2148   *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2149   * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2150   * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2151   * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2152   * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2153   */
2154  enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2155  	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2156  	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2157  	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2158  	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2159  	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2160  	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2161  };
2162  
2163  /**
2164   * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2165   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2166   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2167   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2168   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2169   *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2170   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2171   *
2172   * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2173   *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2174   */
2175  enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2176  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2177  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2178  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2179  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2180  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2181  };
2182  
2183  /**
2184   * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2185   *
2186   * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2187   * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2188   *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2189   */
2190  struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2191  	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2192  	struct {
2193  		s8 idx;
2194  		u8 count;
2195  		u8 count_cts;
2196  		u8 count_rts;
2197  		u16 flags;
2198  	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2199  };
2200  
2201  /**
2202   * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2203   *
2204   * Used to configure txpower for station.
2205   *
2206   * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2207   *	to the STA.
2208   * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2209   *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2210   *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2211   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2212   *	per peer TPC.
2213   */
2214  struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2215  	s16 power;
2216  	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2217  };
2218  
2219  /**
2220   * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2221   *
2222   * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2223   * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2224   *
2225   * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2226   *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2227   *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2228   *
2229   *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2230   *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2231   *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2232   *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2233   *
2234   * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2235   * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2236   * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2237   * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2238   * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2239   */
2240  struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2241  	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2242  
2243  	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2244  	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2245  };
2246  
2247  /**
2248   * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2249   * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2250   * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2251   *
2252   * @sta: reference to owning STA
2253   * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2254   *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2255   *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2256   * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2257   * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2258   * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2259   * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2260   * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2261   * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2262   * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2263   * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2264   * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2265   * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2266   * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2267   *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2268   *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2269   *	the station moves to associated state.
2270   * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2271   *
2272   */
2273  struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2274  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2275  
2276  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2277  	u8 link_id;
2278  	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2279  
2280  	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2281  	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2282  	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2283  	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2284  	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2285  	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2286  
2287  	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2288  
2289  	u8 rx_nss;
2290  	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2291  	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2292  };
2293  
2294  /**
2295   * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2296   *
2297   * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2298   * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2299   * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2300   * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2301   * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2302   * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2303   * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2304   * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2305   *
2306   * @addr: MAC address
2307   * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2308   * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2309   *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2310   *	Can be modified by driver.
2311   * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2312   *	otherwise always false)
2313   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2314   *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2315   * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2316   *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2317   *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2318   * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2319   * @rates: rate control selection table
2320   * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2321   * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2322   *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2323   * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2324   * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2325   * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2326   *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2327   *	unlimited.
2328   * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2329   *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2330   *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2331   * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2332   * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2333   *	is used for non-data frames
2334   * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2335   *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2336   *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2337   *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2338   * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2339   *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2340   *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2341   *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2342   *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2343   *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2344   *	by the AP.
2345   * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2346   */
2347  struct ieee80211_sta {
2348  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2349  	u16 aid;
2350  	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2351  	bool wme;
2352  	u8 uapsd_queues;
2353  	u8 max_sp;
2354  	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2355  	bool tdls;
2356  	bool tdls_initiator;
2357  	bool mfp;
2358  	bool mlo;
2359  	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2360  
2361  	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2362  
2363  	bool support_p2p_ps;
2364  
2365  	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2366  
2367  	u16 valid_links;
2368  	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2369  	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2370  
2371  	/* must be last */
2372  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2373  };
2374  
2375  #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2376  bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2377  #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2378  static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2379  {
2380  	return true;
2381  }
2382  #endif
2383  
2384  #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2385  	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2386  				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2387  
2388  #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2389  	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2390  			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2391  
2392  #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2393  	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2394  		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2395  		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2396  		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2397  
2398  /**
2399   * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2400   *
2401   * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2402   * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2403   *
2404   * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2405   * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2406   */
2407  enum sta_notify_cmd {
2408  	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2409  };
2410  
2411  /**
2412   * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2413   *
2414   * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2415   * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2416   */
2417  struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2418  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2419  };
2420  
2421  /**
2422   * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2423   *
2424   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2425   * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2426   * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2427   *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2428   * @ac: the AC for this queue
2429   * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2430   *
2431   * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2432   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2433   */
2434  struct ieee80211_txq {
2435  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2436  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2437  	u8 tid;
2438  	u8 ac;
2439  
2440  	/* must be last */
2441  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2442  };
2443  
2444  /**
2445   * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2446   *
2447   * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2448   * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2449   * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2450   * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2451   * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2452   *
2453   * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2454   *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2455   *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2456   *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2457   *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2458   *	algorithm.
2459   *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2460   *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2461   *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2462   *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2463   *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2464   *	CCK frames.
2465   *
2466   * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2467   *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2468   *	the FCS at the end.
2469   *
2470   * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2471   *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2472   *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2473   *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2474   *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2475   *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2476   *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2477   *
2478   * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2479   *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2480   *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2481   *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2482   *
2483   * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2484   *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2485   *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2486   *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2487   *
2488   * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2489   * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2490   * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2491   *
2492   * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2493   *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2494   *
2495   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2496   *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2497   *
2498   * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2499   *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2500   *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2501   *
2502   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2503   *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2504   *
2505   * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2506   *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2507   *
2508   * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2509   *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2510   *	the stack.
2511   *
2512   * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2513   *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2514   *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2515   *
2516   * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2517   *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2518   *	dtim_period).
2519   *
2520   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2521   *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2522   *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2523   *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2524   *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2525   *	only in that case.
2526   *
2527   * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2528   *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2529   *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2530   *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2531   *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2532   *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2533   *
2534   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2535   *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2536   *	software.
2537   *
2538   * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2539   *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2540   *	active interfaces.
2541   *
2542   * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2543   *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2544   *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2545   *
2546   * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2547   *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2548   *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2549   *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2550   *	supported cipher suites.
2551   *
2552   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2553   *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2554   *	for frames.
2555   *
2556   * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2557   *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2558   *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2559   *	control for more details.
2560   *
2561   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2562   *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2563   *
2564   * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2565   *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2566   *	is supported.
2567   *
2568   * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2569   *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2570   *
2571   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2572   *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2573   *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2574   *
2575   * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2576   *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2577   *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2578   *	CSA frame.
2579   *
2580   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2581   *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2582   *
2583   * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2584   *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2585   *
2586   * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2587   *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2588   *
2589   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2590   *	within A-MPDU.
2591   *
2592   * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2593   *	for sent beacons.
2594   *
2595   * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2596   *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2597   *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2598   *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2599   *
2600   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2601   *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2602   *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2603   *	timeout.
2604   *
2605   * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2606   *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2607   *
2608   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2609   *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2610   *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2611   *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2612   *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2613   *
2614   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2615   *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2616   *
2617   * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2618   *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2619   *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2620   *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2621   *
2622   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2623   *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2624   *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2625   *
2626   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2627   *	TDLS links.
2628   *
2629   * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2630   *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2631   *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2632   *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2633   *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2634   *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2635   *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2636   *
2637   * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2638   *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2639   *
2640   * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2641   *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2642   *
2643   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2644   *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2645   *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2646   *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2647   *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2648   *
2649   * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2650   *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2651   *	TXQs to start with.
2652   *
2653   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2654   *	length in tx status information
2655   *
2656   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2657   *
2658   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2659   *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2660   *
2661   * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2662   *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2663   *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2664   *
2665   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2666   *	offload
2667   *
2668   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2669   *	offload
2670   *
2671   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2672   *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2673   *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2674   *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2675   *	the stack.
2676   *
2677   * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2678   *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2679   *
2680   * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2681   *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2682   *
2683   * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2684   */
2685  enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2686  	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2687  	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2688  	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2689  	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2690  	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2691  	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2692  	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2693  	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2694  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2695  	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2696  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2697  	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2698  	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2699  	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2700  	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2701  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2702  	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2703  	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2704  	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2705  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2706  	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2707  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2708  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2709  	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2710  	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2711  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2712  	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2713  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2714  	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2715  	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2716  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2717  	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2718  	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2719  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2720  	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2721  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2722  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2723  	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2724  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2725  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2726  	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2727  	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2728  	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2729  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2730  	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2731  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2732  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2733  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2734  	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2735  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2736  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2737  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2738  	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2739  	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2740  
2741  	/* keep last, obviously */
2742  	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2743  };
2744  
2745  /**
2746   * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2747   *
2748   * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2749   * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2750   *
2751   * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2752   *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2753   *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2754   *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2755   *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2756   *
2757   * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2758   *
2759   * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2760   *	along with this structure.
2761   *
2762   * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2763   *
2764   * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2765   *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2766   *
2767   * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2768   *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2769   *
2770   * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2771   *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2772   *
2773   * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2774   *	that HW supports
2775   *
2776   * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2777   *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2778   *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2779   *
2780   * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2781   *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2782   *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2783   *
2784   * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2785   *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2786   * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2787   *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2788   * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2789   *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2790   * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2791   *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2792   *
2793   * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2794   *	can handle.
2795   * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2796   *	the hw can report back.
2797   * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2798   *
2799   * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2800   *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2801   *	aggregation.
2802   *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2803   *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2804   *	it shouldn't be set.
2805   *
2806   * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2807   *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2808   *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2809   *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2810   *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2811   *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2812   *
2813   * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2814   *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2815   *
2816   * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2817   *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2818   *
2819   * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2820   *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2821   *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2822   *	adding _BW is supported today.
2823   *
2824   * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2825   *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2826   *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2827   *
2828   * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2829   *
2830   * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2831   *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2832   *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2833   *	device_timestamp.
2834   * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2835   *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2836   *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2837   * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2838   *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2839   *
2840   * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2841   *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2842   *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2843   *
2844   * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2845   *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2846   *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2847   *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2848   *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2849   *	neither enabled.
2850   *
2851   * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2852   *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2853   *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2854   *
2855   * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2856   *	device.
2857   *
2858   * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2859   *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2860   *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2861   *
2862   * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2863   *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2864   *
2865   * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2866   *
2867   * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2868   * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2869   * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2870   *
2871   * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2872   */
2873  struct ieee80211_hw {
2874  	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2875  	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2876  	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2877  	void *priv;
2878  	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2879  	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2880  	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2881  	int vif_data_size;
2882  	int sta_data_size;
2883  	int chanctx_data_size;
2884  	int txq_data_size;
2885  	u16 queues;
2886  	u16 max_listen_interval;
2887  	s8 max_signal;
2888  	u8 max_rates;
2889  	u8 max_report_rates;
2890  	u8 max_rate_tries;
2891  	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2892  	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2893  	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2894  	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2895  	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2896  	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2897  	struct {
2898  		int units_pos;
2899  		s16 accuracy;
2900  	} radiotap_timestamp;
2901  	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2902  	u8 uapsd_queues;
2903  	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2904  	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2905  	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2906  	u8 weight_multiplier;
2907  	u32 max_mtu;
2908  	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2909  	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2910  };
2911  
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2912  static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2913  				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2914  {
2915  	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2916  }
2917  #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2918  
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2919  static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2920  				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2921  {
2922  	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2923  }
2924  #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2925  
2926  /**
2927   * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2928   *
2929   * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2930   * @req: cfg80211 request.
2931   */
2932  struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2933  	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2934  
2935  	/* Keep last */
2936  	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2937  };
2938  
2939  /**
2940   * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2941   *
2942   * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2943   * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2944   * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2945   * @status: channel-switch response status
2946   * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2947   * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2948   * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2949   * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2950   * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2951   */
2952  struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2953  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2954  	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2955  	u8 action_code;
2956  	u32 status;
2957  	u32 timestamp;
2958  	u16 switch_time;
2959  	u16 switch_timeout;
2960  	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2961  	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2962  };
2963  
2964  /**
2965   * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2966   *
2967   * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2968   *
2969   * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2970   * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2971   * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2972   * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2973   * is already used internally by mac80211.
2974   *
2975   * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2976   */
2977  struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2978  
2979  /**
2980   * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2981   *
2982   * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2983   * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2984   */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2985  static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2986  {
2987  	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2988  }
2989  
2990  /**
2991   * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2992   *
2993   * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2994   * @addr: the address to set
2995   */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)2996  static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2997  {
2998  	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2999  }
3000  
3001  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3002  ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3003  		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3004  {
3005  	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3006  		return NULL;
3007  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3008  }
3009  
3010  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3011  ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3012  			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3013  {
3014  	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3015  		return NULL;
3016  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3017  }
3018  
3019  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3020  ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3021  			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3022  {
3023  	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3024  		return NULL;
3025  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3026  }
3027  
3028  /**
3029   * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3030   * @hw: the hardware
3031   * @skb: the skb
3032   *
3033   * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3034   * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3035   */
3036  void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3037  
3038  /**
3039   * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3040   *
3041   * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3042   * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3043   *
3044   * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3045   * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3046   * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3047   * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3048   * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3049   * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3050   * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3051   *
3052   * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3053   * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3054   * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3055   *
3056   * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3057   * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3058   * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3059   * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3060   *
3061   * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3062   * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3063   * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3064   * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3065   *
3066   * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3067   *
3068   * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3069   * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3070   * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3071   * based on the receive flags.
3072   *
3073   * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3074   * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3075   * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3076   * keys.
3077   *
3078   * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3079   * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3080   * handler.
3081   * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3082   * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3083   * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3084   * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3085   * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3086   * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3087   *
3088   * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3089   * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3090   * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3091   *
3092   * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3093   * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3094   * requirements:
3095   * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3096        once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3097     2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3098        at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3099     3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3100        encrypted with the new key when also needing
3101        @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3102     4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3103     Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3104   */
3105  
3106  /**
3107   * DOC: Powersave support
3108   *
3109   * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3110   *
3111   * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3112   * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3113   * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3114   * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3115   * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3116   * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3117   * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3118   * it finds traffic directed to it.
3119   *
3120   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3121   * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3122   * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3123   * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3124   * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3125   *
3126   * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3127   * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3128   * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3129   *
3130   * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3131   * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3132   * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3133   * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3134   * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3135   * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3136   * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3137   *
3138   * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3139   * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3140   * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3141   * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3142   * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3143   * periods.
3144   *
3145   * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3146   * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3147   * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3148   * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3149   * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3150   * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3151   * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3152   * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3153   * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3154   * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3155   *
3156   * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3157   * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3158   * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3159   * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3160   * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3161   * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3162   *
3163   * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3164   * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3165   */
3166  
3167  /**
3168   * DOC: Beacon filter support
3169   *
3170   * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3171   * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3172   * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3173   * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3174   * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3175   * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3176   * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3177   *
3178   * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3179   * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3180   * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3181   * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3182   * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3183   *
3184   * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3185   * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3186   * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3187   * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3188   *
3189   * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3190   * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3191   * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3192   * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3193   *
3194   *  - a list of information element IDs
3195   *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3196   *
3197   * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3198   * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3199   * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3200   * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3201   * vendor information elements.
3202   *
3203   * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3204   * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3205   *
3206   * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3207   * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3208   * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3209   * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3210   * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3211   * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3212   *
3213   *
3214   * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3215   * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3216   * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3217   * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3218   * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3219   * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3220   * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3221   * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3222   *
3223   * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3224   * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3225   * signal strength threshold checking.
3226   */
3227  
3228  /**
3229   * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3230   *
3231   * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3232   * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3233   * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3234   * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3235   *
3236   * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3237   * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3238   * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3239   * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3240   * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3241   * hardware flags.
3242   *
3243   * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3244   * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3245   * turned off otherwise.
3246   *
3247   * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3248   * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3249   * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3250   * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3251   */
3252  
3253  /**
3254   * DOC: Frame filtering
3255   *
3256   * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3257   * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3258   * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3259   * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3260   * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3261   *
3262   * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3263   * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3264   * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3265   *
3266   * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3267   * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3268   * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3269   * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3270   * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3271   * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3272   * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3273   *
3274   * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3275   * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3276   * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3277   * or dropped.
3278   *
3279   * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3280   * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3281   * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3282   * the flag, but not clear it.
3283   * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3284   * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3285   * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3286   * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3287   * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3288   * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3289   * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3290   * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3291   */
3292  
3293  /**
3294   * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3295   *
3296   * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3297   * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3298   * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3299   *
3300   * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3301   * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3302   * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3303   * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3304   * the driver code.
3305   *
3306   * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3307   * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3308   * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3309   * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3310   * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3311   * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3312   * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3313   *
3314   * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3315   * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3316   * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3317   * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3318   * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3319   * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3320   * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3321   * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3322   * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3323   * @sta_notify callback.
3324   *
3325   * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3326   * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3327   * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3328   * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3329   * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3330   * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3331   * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3332   * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3333   * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3334   * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3335   * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3336   * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3337   * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3338   * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3339   *
3340   * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3341   * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3342   *
3343   * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3344   * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3345   * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3346   * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3347   * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3348   * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3349   * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3350   * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3351   * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3352   * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3353   * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3354   *
3355   * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3356   * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3357   * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3358   * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3359   * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3360   * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3361   * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3362   * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3363   * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3364   * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3365   * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3366   * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3367   * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3368   * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3369   *
3370   * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3371   * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3372   * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3373   * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3374   * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3375   * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3376   * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3377   *
3378   * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3379   * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3380   * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3381   * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3382   * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3383   *
3384   * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3385   * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3386   * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3387   * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3388   */
3389  
3390  /**
3391   * DOC: HW queue control
3392   *
3393   * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3394   * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3395   * was problematic for a few reasons:
3396   * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3397   * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3398   * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3399   *
3400   * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3401   * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3402   * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3403   *
3404   * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3405   * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3406   * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3407   * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3408   * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3409   * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3410   * the hardware queue.
3411   * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3412   * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3413   *
3414   * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3415   * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3416   * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3417   * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3418   * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3419   *
3420   * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3421   * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3422   * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3423   * off-channel queue:         9
3424   *
3425   * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3426   *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3427   *
3428   * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3429   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3430   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3431   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3432   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3433   *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3434   * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3435   *
3436   * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3437   * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3438   *
3439   * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3440   * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3441   * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3442   * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3443   */
3444  
3445  /**
3446   * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3447   *
3448   * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3449   * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3450   * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3451   * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3452   *
3453   * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3454   *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3455   *	multicast address.
3456   *
3457   * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3458   *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3459   *
3460   * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3461   *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3462   *
3463   * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3464   *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3465   *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3466   *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3467   *	honour this flag if possible.
3468   *
3469   * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3470   *	station
3471   *
3472   * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3473   *
3474   * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3475   *
3476   * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3477   *
3478   * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3479   */
3480  enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3481  	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3482  	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3483  	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3484  	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3485  	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3486  	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3487  	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3488  	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3489  	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3490  };
3491  
3492  /**
3493   * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3494   *
3495   * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3496   * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3497   *
3498   * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3499   * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3500   * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3501   * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3502   *
3503   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3504   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3505   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3506   *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3507   *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3508   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3509   *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3510   *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3511   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3512   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3513   *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3514   *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3515   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3516   *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3517   *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3518   *	session is gone and removes the station.
3519   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3520   *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3521   *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3522   *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3523   */
3524  enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3525  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3526  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3527  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3528  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3529  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3530  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3531  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3532  };
3533  
3534  #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3535  #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3536  
3537  /**
3538   * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3539   *
3540   * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3541   * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3542   * @tid: tid of the BA session
3543   * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3544   *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3545   *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3546   * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3547   *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3548   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3549   * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3550   *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3551   * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3552   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3553   */
3554  struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3555  	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3556  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3557  	u16 tid;
3558  	u16 ssn;
3559  	u16 buf_size;
3560  	bool amsdu;
3561  	u16 timeout;
3562  };
3563  
3564  /**
3565   * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3566   * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3567   * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3568   *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3569   */
3570  enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3571  	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3572  	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3573  };
3574  
3575  /**
3576   * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3577   *
3578   * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3579   *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3580   *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3581   *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3582   * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3583   * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3584   *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3585   *	the peer.
3586   * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3587   *	by the peer
3588   */
3589  enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3590  	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3591  	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3592  	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3593  	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3594  };
3595  
3596  /**
3597   * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3598   *
3599   * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3600   * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3601   * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3602   * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3603   * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3604   *
3605   * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3606   * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3607   *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3608   */
3609  enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3610  	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3611  	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3612  };
3613  
3614  /**
3615   * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3616   *
3617   * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3618   * reconfiguration type was completed.
3619   *
3620   * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3621   *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3622   * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3623   *	of wowlan configuration)
3624   */
3625  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3626  	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3627  	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3628  };
3629  
3630  /**
3631   * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3632   * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3633   *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3634   * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3635   * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3636   *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3637   *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3638   */
3639  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3640  	u16 duration;
3641  	u16 subtype;
3642  	u8 success:1;
3643  };
3644  
3645  /**
3646   * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3647   *
3648   * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3649   * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3650   * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3651   *
3652   * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3653   *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3654   *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3655   *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3656   *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3657   *	Must be atomic.
3658   *
3659   * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3660   *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3661   *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3662   *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3663   *	or zero.
3664   *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3665   *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3666   *	is added.
3667   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3668   *
3669   * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3670   *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3671   *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3672   *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3673   *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3674   *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3675   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3676   *
3677   * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3678   *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3679   *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3680   *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3681   *	reconfigured at resume time.
3682   *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3683   *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3684   *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3685   *	must return 1 from this function.
3686   *
3687   * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3688   *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3689   *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3690   *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3691   *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3692   *
3693   * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3694   *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3695   *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3696   *	in suspend().
3697   *
3698   * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3699   *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3700   *	and @stop must be implemented.
3701   *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3702   *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3703   *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3704   *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3705   *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3706   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3707   *
3708   * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3709   *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3710   *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3711   *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3712   *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3713   *
3714   * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3715   *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3716   *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3717   *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3718   *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3719   *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3720   *	MAC address of the device going away.
3721   *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3722   *
3723   * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3724   *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3725   *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3726   *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3727   *
3728   * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3729   *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3730   *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3731   *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3732   *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3733   *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3734   *	can sleep.
3735   *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3736   *	are not implemented.
3737   *
3738   * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3739   *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3740   *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3741   *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3742   *	The callback can sleep.
3743   *
3744   * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3745   *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3746   *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3747   *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3748   *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3749   *	non-MLO connections.
3750   *	The callback can sleep.
3751   *
3752   * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3753   *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3754   *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3755   *
3756   * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3757   *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3758   *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3759   *
3760   * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3761   *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3762   *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3763   *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3764   *	which flags are changed.
3765   *	This callback can sleep.
3766   *
3767   * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3768   * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3769   *
3770   * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3771   *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3772   *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3773   *	is enabled.
3774   *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3775   *	The callback can sleep.
3776   *
3777   * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3778   * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3779   * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3780   *	The callback must be atomic.
3781   *
3782   * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3783   *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3784   *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3785   *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3786   *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3787   *
3788   * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3789   *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3790   *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3791   *
3792   * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3793   *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3794   *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3795   *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3796   *	that power save is disabled.
3797   *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3798   *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3799   *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3800   *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3801   *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3802   *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3803   *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3804   *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3805   *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3806   *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3807   *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3808   *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3809   *	The callback can sleep.
3810   *
3811   * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3812   *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3813   *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3814   *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3815   *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3816   *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3817   *	The callback can sleep.
3818   *
3819   * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3820   *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3821   *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3822   *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3823   *
3824   * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3825   *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3826   *
3827   * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3828   *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3829   *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3830   *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3831   *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3832   *
3833   * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3834   *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3835   *	this notification.
3836   *	The callback can sleep.
3837   *
3838   * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3839   * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3840   *	The callback can sleep.
3841   *
3842   * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3843   *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3844   *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3845   *	The callback must be atomic.
3846   *
3847   * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3848   *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3849   *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3850   *	should be set as well.
3851   *	The callback can sleep.
3852   *
3853   * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3854   *	The callback can sleep.
3855   *
3856   * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3857   *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3858   *
3859   * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3860   *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3861   *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3862   *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3863   *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3864   *	This callback can sleep.
3865   *
3866   * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3867   *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3868   *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3869   *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3870   *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3871   *
3872   * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3873   *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3874   *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3875   *	callback can sleep.
3876   *
3877   * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3878   *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3879   *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3880   *	callback can sleep.
3881   *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3882   *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3883   *
3884   * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3885   *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3886   *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3887   *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3888   *
3889   * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3890   *	power for the station.
3891   *	This callback can sleep.
3892   *
3893   * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3894   *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3895   *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3896   *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3897   *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3898   *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3899   *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3900   *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3901   *	The callback can sleep.
3902   *
3903   * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3904   *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3905   *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3906   *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3907   *	in @sta_state.
3908   *	The callback can sleep.
3909   *
3910   * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3911   *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3912   *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3913   *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3914   *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3915   *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3916   *	Must be atomic.
3917   * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3918   *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3919   *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3920   *
3921   * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3922   *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3923   *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3924   *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3925   *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3926   *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3927   *	The callback can sleep.
3928   *
3929   * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3930   *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3931   *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3932   *	The callback can sleep.
3933   *
3934   * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3935   *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3936   *	required function.
3937   *	The callback can sleep.
3938   *
3939   * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3940   *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3941   *	required function.
3942   *	The callback can sleep.
3943   *
3944   * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3945   *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3946   *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3947   *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3948   *	The callback can sleep.
3949   *
3950   * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3951   *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3952   *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3953   *	TSF synchronization.
3954   *	The callback can sleep.
3955   *
3956   * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3957   *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3958   *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3959   *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3960   *	The callback can sleep.
3961   *
3962   * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3963   *
3964   * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3965   *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3966   *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3967   *	The callback can sleep.
3968   *
3969   * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3970   *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3971   *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3972   *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3973   *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3974   *
3975   * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3976   *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3977   * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3978   *
3979   * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3980   *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3981   *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3982   *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3983   *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3984   *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3985   *	The callback can sleep.
3986   *
3987   * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
3988   *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
3989   *	The callback can sleep.
3990   *
3991   * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3992   *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3993   *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3994   *	completion of the channel switch.
3995   *
3996   * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3997   *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3998   *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3999   *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4000   *
4001   * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4002   *
4003   * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4004   *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4005   *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4006   *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4007   *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4008   *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4009   *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4010   *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4011   *	must be accepted in this case.
4012   *	This callback may sleep.
4013   * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4014   *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4015   *
4016   * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4017   *
4018   * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4019   *
4020   * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4021   *	queues before entering power save.
4022   *
4023   * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4024   *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4025   *	The callback can sleep.
4026   * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4027   *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4028   *	The callback must be atomic.
4029   *
4030   * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4031   *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4032   *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4033   *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4034   *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4035   *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4036   *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4037   *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4038   *	more-data bit must always be set.
4039   *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4040   *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4041   *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4042   *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4043   *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4044   *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4045   *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4046   *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4047   *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4048   *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4049   *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4050   *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4051   *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4052   *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4053   *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4054   *	This callback must be atomic.
4055   * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4056   *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4057   *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4058   *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4059   *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4060   *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4061   *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4062   *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4063   *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4064   *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4065   *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4066   *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4067   *	This callback must be atomic.
4068   *
4069   * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4070   *
4071   * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4072   *
4073   * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4074   *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4075   *
4076   * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4077   *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4078   *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4079   *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4080   *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4081   *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4082   *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4083   *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4084   *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4085   *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4086   *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4087   *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4088   *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4089   *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4090   *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4091   *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4092   *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4093   *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4094   * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4095   *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4096   *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4097   *
4098   * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4099   *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4100   *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4101   *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4102   *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4103   *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4104   *	2 * (DTIM period).
4105   *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4106   *
4107   * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4108   *	This callback may sleep.
4109   * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4110   *	This callback may sleep.
4111   * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4112   *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4113   *	channel context with different settings
4114   *	This callback may sleep.
4115   * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4116   *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4117   *	This callback may sleep.
4118   * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4119   *	unbound from vif.
4120   *	This callback may sleep.
4121   * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4122   *	another, as specified in the list of
4123   *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4124   *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4125   *	This callback may sleep.
4126   *
4127   * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4128   *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4129   *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4130   *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4131   *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4132   *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4133   * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4134   *
4135   * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4136   *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4137   *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4138   *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4139   *	This callback may sleep.
4140   *
4141   * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4142   *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4143   *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4144   *
4145   * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4146   *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4147   *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4148   *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4149   *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4150   *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4151   *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4152   *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4153   *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4154   *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4155   * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4156   *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4157   *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4158   *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4159   * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4160   *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4161   *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4162   * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4163   *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4164   *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4165   * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4166   *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4167   *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4168   * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4169   *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4170   *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4171   * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4172   *
4173   * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4174   *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4175   *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4176   *
4177   * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4178   *	and hardware limits.
4179   *
4180   * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4181   *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4182   *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4183   *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4184   *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4185   *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4186   *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4187   * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4188   *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4189   * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4190   *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4191   *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4192   *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4193   *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4194   *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4195   *	the function call.
4196   *
4197   * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4198   * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4199   *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4200   *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4201   *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4202   *
4203   * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4204   * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4205   * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4206   *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4207   *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4208   *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4209   *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4210   *	changed parameters.
4211   * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4212   *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4213   *	this call.
4214   * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4215   *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4216   *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4217   * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4218   *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4219   *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4220   *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4221   * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4222   *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4223   *
4224   * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4225   * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4226   * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4227   * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4228   *	This callback may sleep.
4229   * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4230   *	This callback may sleep.
4231   * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4232   *	4-address mode
4233   * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4234   * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4235   *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4236   * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4237   *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4238   *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4239   *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4240   *	twt structure.
4241   * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4242   *	from the peer.
4243   * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4244   *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4245   *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4246   *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4247   *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4248   *	radar channel.
4249   *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4250   *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4251   * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4252   *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4253   * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4254   *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4255   *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4256   *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4257   *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4258   *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4259   *	This callback can sleep.
4260   * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4261   *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4262   *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4263   *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4264   *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4265   * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4266   *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4267   *	that.
4268   * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4269   *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4270   *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4271   *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4272   */
4273  struct ieee80211_ops {
4274  	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4275  		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4276  		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4277  	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4278  	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4279  #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4280  	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4281  	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4282  	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4283  #endif
4284  	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4285  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4286  	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4287  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4288  				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4289  	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4290  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4291  	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4292  	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4293  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4294  				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4295  				 u64 changed);
4296  	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4297  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4298  				u64 changed);
4299  	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4300  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4301  				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4302  				  u64 changed);
4303  
4304  	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4305  			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4306  	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4307  			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4308  
4309  	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4310  				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4311  	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4312  				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4313  				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4314  				 u64 multicast);
4315  	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4316  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4317  				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4318  				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4319  	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4320  		       bool set);
4321  	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4322  		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4323  		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4324  	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4325  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4326  				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4327  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4328  				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4329  	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4330  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4331  			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4332  	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4333  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4334  	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4335  		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4336  	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4337  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4338  	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4339  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4340  				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4341  				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4342  	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4343  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4344  	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4346  			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4347  	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4349  	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4350  			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4351  	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4352  			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4353  			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4354  	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4355  	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4356  	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4357  		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4358  	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4359  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4360  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4361  	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4362  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4363  				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4364  				 struct dentry *dir);
4365  	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4366  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4367  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4368  				struct dentry *dir);
4369  	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4370  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4371  				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4372  				     struct dentry *dir);
4373  #endif
4374  	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375  			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4376  	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4377  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4378  			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4379  	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380  			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4381  			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4382  			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4383  	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4384  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4385  				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4386  	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4387  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4388  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4389  			      u32 changed);
4390  	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4391  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4392  				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4393  	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395  			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4396  			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4397  	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398  		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4399  		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4400  		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4401  	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4402  	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4403  			u64 tsf);
4404  	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4405  			   s64 offset);
4406  	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4407  	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4408  
4409  	/**
4410  	 * @ampdu_action:
4411  	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4412  	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4413  	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4414  	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4415  	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4416  	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4417  	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4418  	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4419  	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4420  	 *
4421  	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4422  	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4423  	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4424  	 *
4425  	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4426  	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4427  	 *
4428  	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4429  	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4430  	 * - ``TX:        81``
4431  	 *
4432  	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4433  	 *
4434  	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4435  	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4436  	 * if the session can start immediately.
4437  	 *
4438  	 * The callback can sleep.
4439  	 */
4440  	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4442  			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4443  	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4444  		struct survey_info *survey);
4445  	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4446  	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4447  #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4448  	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4449  			    void *data, int len);
4450  	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4451  			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4452  			     void *data, int len);
4453  #endif
4454  	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455  		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4456  	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4457  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4458  	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4459  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4460  			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4461  	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4462  	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4463  
4464  	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4466  				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4467  				 int duration,
4468  				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4469  	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4470  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4471  	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4472  	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473  			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4474  	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4475  	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4476  				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4477  	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4478  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4479  			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4480  
4481  	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4483  				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4484  				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4485  				      bool more_data);
4486  	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487  					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4488  					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4489  					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4490  					bool more_data);
4491  
4492  	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4493  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4494  	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496  				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4497  	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499  				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4500  
4501  	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4503  				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4504  	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4505  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506  				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4507  
4508  	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509  					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4510  
4511  	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512  			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4513  	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514  			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4515  	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516  			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4517  			       u32 changed);
4518  	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520  				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4521  				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4522  	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524  				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4525  				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4526  	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527  				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4528  				  int n_vifs,
4529  				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4530  
4531  	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532  				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4533  
4534  #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4535  	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4537  				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4538  #endif
4539  	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541  				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4542  	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544  				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4545  
4546  	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4548  	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4550  	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4552  					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4553  
4554  	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4555  	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4556  	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557  				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4558  	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559  			   int *dbm);
4560  
4561  	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4562  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4563  				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4564  				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4565  				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4566  	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567  					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568  					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4569  	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571  					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4572  
4573  	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574  			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4575  	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4576  
4577  	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578  			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579  			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4580  	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4581  			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4582  	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4584  			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4585  	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587  			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4588  	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590  			    u8 instance_id);
4591  	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592  				       struct sk_buff *head,
4593  				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4594  	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596  				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4597  	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4598  			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4599  	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600  			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4601  	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4603  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4604  			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4605  	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4608  	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4610  	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4611  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4612  	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4613  			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4614  	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4615  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4616  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4617  	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4619  			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4620  	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4621  				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4622  	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623  				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4624  	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4625  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4626  				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4627  				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4628  				     struct net_device_path *path);
4629  	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4631  				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4632  				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4633  	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4636  				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4637  	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639  				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4640  	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4641  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4642  			    struct net_device *dev,
4643  			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4644  			    void *type_data);
4645  };
4646  
4647  /**
4648   * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4649   *
4650   * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4651   * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4652   * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4653   * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4654   * @priv_data_len.
4655   *
4656   * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4657   * @ops: callbacks for this device
4658   * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4659   *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4660   *
4661   * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4662   */
4663  struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4664  					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4665  					   const char *requested_name);
4666  
4667  /**
4668   * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4669   *
4670   * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4671   * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4672   * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4673   * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4674   * @priv_data_len.
4675   *
4676   * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4677   * @ops: callbacks for this device
4678   *
4679   * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4680   */
4681  static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4682  struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4683  					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4684  {
4685  	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4686  }
4687  
4688  /**
4689   * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4690   *
4691   * You must call this function before any other functions in
4692   * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4693   * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4694   *
4695   * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4696   *
4697   * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4698   */
4699  int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4700  
4701  /**
4702   * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4703   * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4704   * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4705   *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4706   */
4707  struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4708  	int throughput;
4709  	int blink_time;
4710  };
4711  
4712  /**
4713   * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4714   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4715   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4716   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4717   *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4718   */
4719  enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4720  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4721  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4722  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4723  };
4724  
4725  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4726  const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4727  const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4728  const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4729  const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4730  const char *
4731  __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4732  				   unsigned int flags,
4733  				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4734  				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4735  #endif
4736  /**
4737   * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4738   *
4739   * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4740   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4741   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4742   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4743   *
4744   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4745   *
4746   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4747   */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4748  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4749  {
4750  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4751  	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4752  #else
4753  	return NULL;
4754  #endif
4755  }
4756  
4757  /**
4758   * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4759   *
4760   * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4761   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4762   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4763   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4764   *
4765   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4766   *
4767   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4768   */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4769  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4770  {
4771  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4772  	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4773  #else
4774  	return NULL;
4775  #endif
4776  }
4777  
4778  /**
4779   * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4780   *
4781   * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4782   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4783   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4784   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4785   *
4786   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4787   *
4788   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4789   */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4790  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4791  {
4792  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4793  	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4794  #else
4795  	return NULL;
4796  #endif
4797  }
4798  
4799  /**
4800   * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4801   *
4802   * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4803   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4804   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4805   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4806   *
4807   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4808   *
4809   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4810   */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4811  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4812  {
4813  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4814  	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4815  #else
4816  	return NULL;
4817  #endif
4818  }
4819  
4820  /**
4821   * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4822   * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4823   * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4824   * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4825   * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4826   *
4827   * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4828   * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4829   *
4830   * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4831   */
4832  static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4833  ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4834  				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4835  				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4836  {
4837  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4838  	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4839  						  blink_table_len);
4840  #else
4841  	return NULL;
4842  #endif
4843  }
4844  
4845  /**
4846   * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4847   *
4848   * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4849   * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4850   *
4851   * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4852   */
4853  void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4854  
4855  /**
4856   * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4857   *
4858   * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4859   * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4860   * before calling this function.
4861   *
4862   * @hw: the hardware to free
4863   */
4864  void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4865  
4866  /**
4867   * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4868   *
4869   * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4870   * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4871   * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4872   * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4873   * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4874   * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4875   *
4876   * @hw: the hardware to restart
4877   */
4878  void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4879  
4880  /**
4881   * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4882   *
4883   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4884   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4885   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4886   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4887   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4888   *
4889   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4890   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4891   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4892   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4893   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4894   *
4895   * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4896   *
4897   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4898   * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4899   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4900   * @list: the destination list
4901   */
4902  void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4903  		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4904  
4905  /**
4906   * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4907   *
4908   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4909   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4910   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4911   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4912   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4913   *
4914   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4915   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4916   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4917   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4918   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4919   *
4920   * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4921   *
4922   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4923   * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4924   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4925   * @napi: the NAPI context
4926   */
4927  void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4928  		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4929  
4930  /**
4931   * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4932   *
4933   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4934   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4935   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4936   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4937   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4938   *
4939   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4940   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4941   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4942   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4943   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4944   *
4945   * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4946   *
4947   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4948   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4949   */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4950  static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4951  {
4952  	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4953  }
4954  
4955  /**
4956   * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4957   *
4958   * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4959   * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4960   *
4961   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4962   * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4963   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4964   *
4965   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4966   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4967   */
4968  void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4969  
4970  /**
4971   * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4972   *
4973   * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4974   * (internally disables bottom halves).
4975   *
4976   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4977   * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4978   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4979   *
4980   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4981   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4982   */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4983  static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4984  				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4985  {
4986  	local_bh_disable();
4987  	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4988  	local_bh_enable();
4989  }
4990  
4991  /**
4992   * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4993   *
4994   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4995   * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4996   * entering/leaving PS mode.
4997   *
4998   * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4999   *
5000   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5001   * each other.
5002   *
5003   * @sta: currently connected sta
5004   * @start: start or stop PS
5005   *
5006   * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5007   */
5008  int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5009  
5010  /**
5011   * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5012   *                                  (in process context)
5013   *
5014   * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5015   * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5016   * applies.
5017   *
5018   * @sta: currently connected sta
5019   * @start: start or stop PS
5020   *
5021   * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5022   */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5023  static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5024  						  bool start)
5025  {
5026  	int ret;
5027  
5028  	local_bh_disable();
5029  	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5030  	local_bh_enable();
5031  
5032  	return ret;
5033  }
5034  
5035  /**
5036   * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5037   * @sta: currently connected station
5038   *
5039   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5040   * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5041   * connected station was received.
5042   * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5043   * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5044   * be serialized.
5045   */
5046  void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5047  
5048  /**
5049   * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5050   * @sta: currently connected station
5051   * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5052   *
5053   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5054   * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5055   * from a connected station was received.
5056   * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5057   * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5058   * serialized.
5059   * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5060   * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5061   * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5062   * checks.
5063   */
5064  void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5065  
5066  /*
5067   * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5068   * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5069   */
5070  #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5071  
5072  /**
5073   * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5074   * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5075   * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5076   * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5077   *
5078   * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5079   * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5080   * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5081   *
5082   * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5083   * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5084   * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5085   * call! Beware of the locking!)
5086   *
5087   * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5088   * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5089   * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5090   * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5091   * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5092   * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5093   *
5094   * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5095   * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5096   * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5097   * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5098   * use this API.
5099   */
5100  void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5101  				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5102  
5103  /**
5104   * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5105   *
5106   * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5107   * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5108   * rate selection table for the station entry.
5109   *
5110   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5111   * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5112   * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5113   * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5114   * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5115   */
5116  void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5117  			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5118  			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5119  			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5120  			    int max_rates);
5121  
5122  /**
5123   * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5124   *
5125   * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5126   * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5127   * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5128   * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5129   * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5130   * slow stations to starve).
5131   *
5132   * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5133   * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5134   */
5135  void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5136  					   u32 thr);
5137  
5138  /**
5139   * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5140   *
5141   * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5142   * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5143   * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5144   *
5145   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5146   * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5147   * @info: tx status information
5148   */
5149  void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5150  			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5151  			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5152  
5153  /**
5154   * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5155   *
5156   * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5157   * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5158   * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5159   *
5160   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5161   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5162   * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5163   * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5164   * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5165   *
5166   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5167   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168   */
5169  void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170  			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5171  
5172  /**
5173   * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5174   *
5175   * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5176   * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5177   * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5178   *
5179   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5180   * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5181   * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5182   *
5183   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5184   * @status: tx status information
5185   */
5186  void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5187  			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5188  
5189  /**
5190   * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5191   *
5192   * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5193   * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5194   * specific skbs.
5195   *
5196   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5197   * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5198   * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5199   *
5200   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5201   * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5202   *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5203   * @info: tx status information
5204   */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5205  static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5206  					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5207  					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5208  {
5209  	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5210  		.sta = sta,
5211  		.info = info,
5212  	};
5213  
5214  	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5215  }
5216  
5217  /**
5218   * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5219   *
5220   * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5221   *
5222   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5223   * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5224   * for a single hardware.
5225   *
5226   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5227   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5228   */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5229  static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5230  					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5231  {
5232  	local_bh_disable();
5233  	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5234  	local_bh_enable();
5235  }
5236  
5237  /**
5238   * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5239   *
5240   * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5241   * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5242   *
5243   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5244   * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5245   *
5246   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5247   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5248   */
5249  void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5250  				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5251  
5252  /**
5253   * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5254   *
5255   * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5256   * connected STA.
5257   *
5258   * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5259   * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5260   */
5261  void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5262  
5263  #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5264  
5265  /**
5266   * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5267   * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5268   * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5269   * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5270   *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5271   *	should be ignored.
5272   * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5273   */
5274  struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5275  	u16 tim_offset;
5276  	u16 tim_length;
5277  
5278  	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5279  	u16 mbssid_off;
5280  };
5281  
5282  /**
5283   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5284   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5285   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5286   * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5287   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5288   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5289   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5290   *
5291   * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5292   * obtain the beacon template.
5293   *
5294   * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5295   * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5296   * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5297   * applicable, the CSA count.
5298   *
5299   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5300   *
5301   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5302   */
5303  struct sk_buff *
5304  ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5305  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5306  			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5307  			      unsigned int link_id);
5308  
5309  /**
5310   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5311   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5312   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5313   * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5314   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5315   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5316   * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5317   *
5318   * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5319   * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5320   * requested index.
5321   *
5322   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5323   */
5324  struct sk_buff *
5325  ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5326  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5327  					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5328  					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5329  
5330  /**
5331   * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5332   * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5333   *
5334   * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5335   * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5336   * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5337   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5338   */
5339  struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5340  	u8 cnt;
5341  	struct {
5342  		struct sk_buff *skb;
5343  		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5344  	} bcn[];
5345  };
5346  
5347  /**
5348   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5349   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5350   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5351   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5352   *
5353   * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5354   * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5355   * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5356   * one multiple BSSID element.
5357   *
5358   * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5359   *
5360   * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5361   *	%NULL on error.
5362   */
5363  struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5364  ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5365  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5366  				       unsigned int link_id);
5367  
5368  /**
5369   * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5370   * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5371   *
5372   * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5373   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5374   */
5375  void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5376  
5377  /**
5378   * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5379   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5380   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5381   * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5382   *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5383   * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5384   *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5385   *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5386   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5387   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5388   *
5389   * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5390   * obtain the beacon frame.
5391   *
5392   * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5393   * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5394   * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5395   * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5396   *
5397   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5398   *
5399   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5400   */
5401  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5402  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5403  					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5404  					 unsigned int link_id);
5405  
5406  /**
5407   * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5408   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5409   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5410   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5411   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5412   *
5413   * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5414   *
5415   * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5416   */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5417  static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5418  						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5419  						   unsigned int link_id)
5420  {
5421  	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5422  }
5423  
5424  /**
5425   * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5426   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5427   *
5428   * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5429   * This function is called implicitly when
5430   * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5431   * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5432   * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5433   *
5434   * Return: new countdown value
5435   */
5436  u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5437  
5438  /**
5439   * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5440   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5441   * @counter: the new value for the counter
5442   *
5443   * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5444   * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5445   *
5446   * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5447   * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5448   */
5449  void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5450  
5451  /**
5452   * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5453   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5454   *
5455   * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5456   * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5457   * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5458   */
5459  void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5460  
5461  /**
5462   * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5463   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5464   *
5465   * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5466   */
5467  bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5468  
5469  /**
5470   * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5471   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5472   *
5473   * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5474   * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5475   * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5476   */
5477  void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5478  
5479  /**
5480   * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5481   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5482   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5483   *
5484   * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5485   * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5486   *
5487   * Can only be called in AP mode.
5488   *
5489   * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5490   */
5491  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5492  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5493  
5494  /**
5495   * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5496   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5497   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5498   *
5499   * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5500   * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5501   * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5502   *
5503   * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5504   * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5505   *
5506   * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5507   */
5508  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5509  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5510  
5511  /**
5512   * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5513   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5514   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5515   * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5516   *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5517   *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5518   * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5519   *	if at all possible
5520   *
5521   * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5522   * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5523   * BSSID and address is used.
5524   *
5525   * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5526   * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5527   *
5528   * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5529   * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5530   *
5531   * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5532   */
5533  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5534  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5535  				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5536  
5537  /**
5538   * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5539   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5540   * @src_addr: source MAC address
5541   * @ssid: SSID buffer
5542   * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5543   * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5544   *
5545   * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5546   * hardware.
5547   *
5548   * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5549   */
5550  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551  				       const u8 *src_addr,
5552  				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5553  				       size_t tailroom);
5554  
5555  /**
5556   * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5557   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5558   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5559   * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5560   * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5561   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5562   * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5563   *
5564   * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5565   * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5566   * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5567   * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5568   */
5569  void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5570  		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5571  		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5572  		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5573  
5574  /**
5575   * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5576   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5577   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5578   * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5579   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5580   *
5581   * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5582   * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5583   * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5584   *
5585   * Return: The duration.
5586   */
5587  __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5588  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5589  			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5590  
5591  /**
5592   * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5593   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5594   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5595   * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5596   * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5597   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5598   * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5599   *
5600   * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5601   * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5602   * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5603   * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5604   */
5605  void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5606  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5607  			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5608  			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5609  			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5610  
5611  /**
5612   * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5613   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5614   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5615   * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5616   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5617   *
5618   * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5619   * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5620   * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5621   *
5622   * Return: The duration.
5623   */
5624  __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5625  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5626  				    size_t frame_len,
5627  				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5628  
5629  /**
5630   * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5631   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5632   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5633   * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5634   * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5635   * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5636   *
5637   * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5638   * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5639   *
5640   * Return: The duration.
5641   */
5642  __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5643  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5644  					enum nl80211_band band,
5645  					size_t frame_len,
5646  					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5647  
5648  /**
5649   * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5650   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5651   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5652   *
5653   * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5654   * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5655   * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5656   * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5657   * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5658   *
5659   * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5660   * frames are available.
5661   *
5662   * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5663   * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5664   * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5665   * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5666   * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5667   * use common code for all beacons.
5668   */
5669  struct sk_buff *
5670  ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5671  
5672  /**
5673   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5674   *
5675   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5676   *
5677   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5678   * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5679   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5680   */
5681  void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5682  			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5683  
5684  /**
5685   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5686   *
5687   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5688   * from the given packet.
5689   *
5690   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5691   * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5692   *	with this P1K
5693   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5694   */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5695  static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5696  					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5697  {
5698  	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5699  	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5700  	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5701  
5702  	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5703  }
5704  
5705  /**
5706   * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5707   *
5708   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5709   * and transmitter address.
5710   *
5711   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5712   * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5713   * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5714   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5715   */
5716  void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5717  			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5718  
5719  /**
5720   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5721   *
5722   * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5723   * in the packet.
5724   *
5725   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5726   * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5727   *	encrypted with this key
5728   * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5729   */
5730  void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5731  			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5732  
5733  /**
5734   * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5735   *
5736   * @pos: start of crypto header
5737   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5738   * @pn: PN to add
5739   *
5740   * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5741   * the packet payload)
5742   *
5743   * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5744   * point to the crypto header)
5745   */
5746  u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5747  
5748  /**
5749   * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5750   *
5751   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5752   * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5753   *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5754   *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5755   * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5756   *
5757   * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5758   * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5759   * by the device and not by mac80211.
5760   *
5761   * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5762   * can be done concurrently.
5763   */
5764  void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5765  			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5766  
5767  /**
5768   * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5769   *
5770   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5771   * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5772   *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5773   *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5774   * @seq: new sequence data
5775   *
5776   * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5777   * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5778   * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5779   * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5780   *
5781   * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5782   * can be done concurrently.
5783   */
5784  void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5785  			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5786  
5787  /**
5788   * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5789   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5790   *
5791   * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5792   * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5793   * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5794   *
5795   * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5796   * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5797   */
5798  void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5799  
5800  /**
5801   * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5802   * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5803   * @keyconf: new key data
5804   *
5805   * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5806   * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5807   * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5808   *
5809   * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5810   * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5811   * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5812   * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5813   *
5814   * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5815   * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5816   * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5817   * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5818   * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5819   * of the reconfiguration.
5820   *
5821   * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5822   * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5823   *
5824   * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5825   * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5826   * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5827   * the key that's being replaced.
5828   */
5829  struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5830  ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5831  			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5832  
5833  /**
5834   * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5835   * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5836   * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5837   * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5838   * @gfp: allocation flags
5839   */
5840  void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5841  				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5842  
5843  /**
5844   * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5845   *
5846   * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5847   * at the same time.
5848   *
5849   * @keyconf: the key in question
5850   */
5851  void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5852  
5853  /**
5854   * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5855   *
5856   * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5857   * at the same time.
5858   *
5859   * @keyconf: the key in question
5860   */
5861  void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5862  
5863  /**
5864   * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5865   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5866   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5867   *
5868   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5869   */
5870  void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5871  
5872  /**
5873   * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5874   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5875   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5876   *
5877   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5878   */
5879  void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5880  
5881  /**
5882   * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5883   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5884   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5885   *
5886   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5887   *
5888   * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5889   */
5890  
5891  int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5892  
5893  /**
5894   * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5895   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5896   *
5897   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5898   */
5899  void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5900  
5901  /**
5902   * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5903   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5904   *
5905   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5906   */
5907  void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5908  
5909  /**
5910   * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5911   *
5912   * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5913   * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5914   * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5915   * any context, including hardirq context.
5916   *
5917   * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5918   * @info: information about the completed scan
5919   */
5920  void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5921  			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5922  
5923  /**
5924   * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5925   *
5926   * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5927   * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5928   *
5929   * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5930   */
5931  void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5932  
5933  /**
5934   * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5935   *
5936   * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5937   * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5938   * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5939   * while associating, for instance.
5940   *
5941   * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5942   */
5943  void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5944  
5945  /**
5946   * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5947   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5948   *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5949   *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5950   *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5951   *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5952   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5953   *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5954   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5955   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5956   *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5957   *	for instance.
5958   */
5959  enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5960  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5961  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5962  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5963  	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5964  };
5965  
5966  /**
5967   * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5968   *
5969   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5970   * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5971   * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5972   * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5973   *
5974   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5975   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5976   * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5977   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5978   */
5979  void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5980  				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5981  						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5982  				  void *data);
5983  
5984  /**
5985   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5986   *
5987   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5988   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5989   * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5990   * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5991   * be used.
5992   * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5993   *
5994   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5995   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5996   * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5997   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5998   */
5999  static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6000  ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6001  				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6002  						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6003  				    void *data)
6004  {
6005  	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6006  				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6007  				     iterator, data);
6008  }
6009  
6010  /**
6011   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6012   *
6013   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6014   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6015   * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6016   * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6017   * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6018   *
6019   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6020   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6021   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6022   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6023   */
6024  void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6025  						u32 iter_flags,
6026  						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6027  						    u8 *mac,
6028  						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6029  						void *data);
6030  
6031  /**
6032   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6033   *
6034   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6035   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6036   * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6037   *
6038   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6039   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6040   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6041   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6042   */
6043  void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6044  					     u32 iter_flags,
6045  					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6046  						u8 *mac,
6047  						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6048  					     void *data);
6049  
6050  /**
6051   * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6052   *
6053   * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6054   * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6055   * function for them.
6056   * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6057   *
6058   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6059   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6060   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6061   */
6062  void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6063  				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6064  						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6065  				       void *data);
6066  /**
6067   * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6068   *
6069   * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6070   * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6071   *
6072   * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6073   * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6074   */
6075  void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6076  
6077  /**
6078   * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6079   *
6080   * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6081   * workqueue.
6082   *
6083   * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6084   * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6085   * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6086   */
6087  void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6088  				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6089  				  unsigned long delay);
6090  
6091  /**
6092   * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6093   * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6094   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6095   *
6096   * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6097   * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6098   * mac80211.
6099   *
6100   * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6101   */
6102  void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6103  					    u16 tid);
6104  
6105  /**
6106   * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6107   * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6108   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6109   * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6110   *
6111   * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6112   *
6113   * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6114   * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6115   * will be managed by the mac80211.
6116   */
6117  int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6118  				  u16 timeout);
6119  
6120  /**
6121   * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6122   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6123   * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6124   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6125   *
6126   * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6127   * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6128   * from any context.
6129   */
6130  void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6131  				      u16 tid);
6132  
6133  /**
6134   * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6135   * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6136   * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6137   *
6138   * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6139   *
6140   * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6141   * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6142   * will be managed by the mac80211.
6143   */
6144  int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6145  
6146  /**
6147   * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6148   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6149   * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6150   * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6151   *
6152   * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6153   * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6154   * can be called from any context.
6155   */
6156  void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6157  				     u16 tid);
6158  
6159  /**
6160   * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6161   *
6162   * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6163   * @addr: station's address
6164   *
6165   * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6166   *
6167   * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6168   * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6169   */
6170  struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6171  					 const u8 *addr);
6172  
6173  /**
6174   * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6175   *
6176   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6177   * @addr: remote station's address
6178   * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6179   *
6180   * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6181   *
6182   * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6183   * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6184   *
6185   * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6186   *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6187   *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6188   *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6189   *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6190   *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6191   *      is not reliable.
6192   *
6193   * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6194   */
6195  struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6196  					       const u8 *addr,
6197  					       const u8 *localaddr);
6198  
6199  /**
6200   * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6201   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6202   * @addr: remote station's link address
6203   * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6204   * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6205   *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6206   *
6207   * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6208   */
6209  struct ieee80211_sta *
6210  ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6211  				 const u8 *addr,
6212  				 const u8 *localaddr,
6213  				 unsigned int *link_id);
6214  
6215  /**
6216   * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6217   * @hw: the hardware
6218   * @pubsta: the station
6219   * @block: whether to block or unblock
6220   *
6221   * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6222   * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6223   * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6224   * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6225   * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6226   *
6227   * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6228   * manner.
6229   *
6230   * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6231   * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6232   * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6233   * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6234   * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6235   * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6236   * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6237   * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6238   * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6239   * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6240   * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6241   * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6242   * woke up while blocked or not.
6243   */
6244  void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6245  			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6246  
6247  /**
6248   * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6249   * @pubsta: the station
6250   *
6251   * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6252   * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6253   * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6254   * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6255   *
6256   * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6257   * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6258   * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6259   * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6260   *
6261   * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6262   *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6263   *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6264   *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6265   */
6266  void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6267  
6268  /**
6269   * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6270   * @pubsta: the station
6271   * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6272   *
6273   * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6274   * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6275   * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6276   * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6277   * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6278   * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6279   * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6280   * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6281   * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6282   * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6283   * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6284   * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6285   * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6286   * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6287   */
6288  void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6289  
6290  /**
6291   * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6292   * @pubsta: the station
6293   *
6294   * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6295   * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6296   * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6297   *
6298   * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6299   * there is no need to call this function.
6300   */
6301  void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6302  
6303  /**
6304   * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6305   *
6306   * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6307   * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6308   * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6309   * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6310   *
6311   * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6312   * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6313   * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6314   * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6315   * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6316   * attempts.
6317   *
6318   * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6319   * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6320   * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6321   * them to 0.
6322   *
6323   * @pubsta: the station
6324   * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6325   * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6326   * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6327   */
6328  void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6329  				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6330  
6331  /**
6332   * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6333   *
6334   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6335   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6336   *
6337   * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6338   * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6339   */
6340  bool
6341  ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6342  
6343  /**
6344   * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6345   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6346   * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6347   * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6348   * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6349   *
6350   * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6351   * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6352   * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6353   * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6354   * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6355   * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6356   *
6357   * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6358   * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6359   * set_key callback.
6360   */
6361  void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6362  			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6363  			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6364  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6365  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6366  				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6367  				      void *data),
6368  			 void *iter_data);
6369  
6370  /**
6371   * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6372   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6373   * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6374   * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6375   * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6376   *
6377   * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6378   * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6379   * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6380   * in removal process will be skipped.
6381   *
6382   * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6383   * and thus iter must be atomic.
6384   */
6385  void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6386  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6387  			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6388  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6389  					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6390  					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6391  					  void *data),
6392  			     void *iter_data);
6393  
6394  /**
6395   * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6396   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6397   * @iter: iterator function
6398   * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6399   *
6400   * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6401   * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6402   * places while calling into the driver.
6403   *
6404   * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6405   * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6406   * removed.
6407   *
6408   * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6409   * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6410   * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6411   * or not.
6412   */
6413  void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6414  	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6415  	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6416  		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6417  		     void *data),
6418  	void *iter_data);
6419  
6420  /**
6421   * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6422   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6423   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6424   *
6425   * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6426   * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6427   * information. This function must only be called from within the
6428   * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6429   * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6430   * %NULL.
6431   *
6432   * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6433   */
6434  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6435  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6436  
6437  /**
6438   * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6439   *
6440   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6441   *
6442   * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6443   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6444   * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6445   */
6446  void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6447  
6448  /**
6449   * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6450   *
6451   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6452   *
6453   * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6454   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6455   * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6456   * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6457   * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6458   *
6459   * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6460   * without connection recovery attempts.
6461   */
6462  void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6463  
6464  /**
6465   * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6466   *
6467   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6468   * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6469   *
6470   * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6471   * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6472   */
6473  void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6474  
6475  /**
6476   * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6477   *
6478   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6479   *
6480   * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6481   * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6482   * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6483   * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6484   * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6485   *
6486   * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6487   * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6488   * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6489   * disconnect normally later.
6490   *
6491   * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6492   * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6493   * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6494   * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6495   */
6496  void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6497  
6498  /**
6499   * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6500   * hardware restart
6501   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6502   *
6503   * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6504   * hardware restart.
6505   */
6506  void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6507  
6508  /**
6509   * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6510   *	rssi threshold triggered
6511   *
6512   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6513   * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6514   * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6515   * @gfp: context flags
6516   *
6517   * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6518   * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6519   * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6520   */
6521  void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6522  			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6523  			       s32 rssi_level,
6524  			       gfp_t gfp);
6525  
6526  /**
6527   * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6528   *
6529   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6530   * @gfp: context flags
6531   */
6532  void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6533  
6534  /**
6535   * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6536   *
6537   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6538   */
6539  void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6540  
6541  /**
6542   * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6543   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6544   * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6545   *
6546   * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6547   * and wake up the suspended queues.
6548   */
6549  void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6550  
6551  /**
6552   * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6553   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6554   * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6555   *
6556   * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6557   * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6558   * a deauth frame in this case.
6559   */
6560  void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6561  					 bool block_tx);
6562  
6563  /**
6564   * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6565   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6566   * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6567   * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6568   *
6569   * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6570   * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6571   * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6572   */
6573  void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6574  			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6575  
6576  /**
6577   * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6578   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6579   */
6580  void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6581  
6582  /**
6583   * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6584   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6585   */
6586  void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6587  
6588  /**
6589   * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6590   *
6591   * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6592   * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6593   * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6594   * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6595   * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6596   * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6597   *
6598   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6599   * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6600   * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6601   */
6602  void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6603  				  const u8 *addr);
6604  
6605  /**
6606   * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6607   * @pubsta: station struct
6608   * @tid: the session's TID
6609   * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6610   *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6611   * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6612   * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6613   *
6614   * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6615   * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6616   * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6617   * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6618   * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6619   */
6620  void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6621  					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6622  					  u16 received_mpdus);
6623  
6624  /**
6625   * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6626   *
6627   * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6628   * buffer.
6629   *
6630   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6631   * @ra: the peer's destination address
6632   * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6633   * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6634   */
6635  void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6636  
6637  /**
6638   * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6639   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6640   * @addr: station mac address
6641   * @tid: the rx tid
6642   */
6643  void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6644  				 unsigned int tid);
6645  
6646  /**
6647   * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6648   *
6649   * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6650   * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6651   * reordering.
6652   *
6653   * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6654   * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6655   *
6656   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6657   * @addr: station mac address
6658   * @tid: the rx tid
6659   */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6660  static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6661  						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6662  {
6663  	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6664  		return;
6665  	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6666  }
6667  
6668  /**
6669   * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6670   *
6671   * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6672   * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6673   * reordering.
6674   *
6675   * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6676   * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6677   *
6678   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6679   * @addr: station mac address
6680   * @tid: the rx tid
6681   */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6682  static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6683  						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6684  {
6685  	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6686  		return;
6687  	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6688  }
6689  
6690  /**
6691   * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6692   *
6693   * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6694   * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6695   *
6696   * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6697   *
6698   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6699   * @addr: station mac address
6700   * @tid: the rx tid
6701   */
6702  void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6703  				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6704  
6705  /* Rate control API */
6706  
6707  /**
6708   * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6709   *
6710   * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6711   * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6712   * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6713   * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6714   *	to be filled in
6715   * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6716   *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6717   *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6718   * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6719   *	RTS threshold
6720   * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6721   *	if the selected rate supports it
6722   * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6723   * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6724   * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6725   */
6726  struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6727  	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6728  	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6729  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6730  	struct sk_buff *skb;
6731  	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6732  	bool rts, short_preamble;
6733  	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6734  	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6735  	bool bss;
6736  };
6737  
6738  /**
6739   * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6740   */
6741  enum rate_control_capabilities {
6742  	/**
6743  	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6744  	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6745  	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6746  	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6747  	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6748  	 */
6749  	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6750  	/**
6751  	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6752  	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6753  	 */
6754  	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6755  };
6756  
6757  struct rate_control_ops {
6758  	unsigned long capa;
6759  	const char *name;
6760  	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6761  	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6762  			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6763  	void (*free)(void *priv);
6764  
6765  	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6766  	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6767  			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6768  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6769  	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6770  			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6771  			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6772  			    u32 changed);
6773  	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6774  			 void *priv_sta);
6775  
6776  	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6777  			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6778  			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6779  	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6780  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6781  			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6782  	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6783  			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6784  
6785  	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6786  				struct dentry *dir);
6787  
6788  	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6789  };
6790  
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)6791  static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6792  				 enum nl80211_band band,
6793  				 int index)
6794  {
6795  	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6796  }
6797  
6798  static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6799  rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6800  		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6801  {
6802  	int i;
6803  
6804  	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6805  		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6806  			return i;
6807  
6808  	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6809  	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6810  
6811  	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6812  	return 0;
6813  }
6814  
6815  static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6816  bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6817  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6818  {
6819  	unsigned int i;
6820  
6821  	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6822  		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6823  			return true;
6824  	return false;
6825  }
6826  
6827  /**
6828   * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6829   *
6830   * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6831   * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6832   * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6833   * the most recent rate control module decision.
6834   *
6835   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6836   * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6837   * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6838   */
6839  int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6840  			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6841  			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6842  
6843  int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6844  void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6845  
6846  static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6847  conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6848  {
6849  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6850  }
6851  
6852  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6853  conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6854  {
6855  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6856  	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6857  }
6858  
6859  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6860  conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6861  {
6862  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6863  	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6864  }
6865  
6866  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6867  conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6868  {
6869  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6870  }
6871  
6872  static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6873  conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6874  {
6875  	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6876  		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6877  		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6878  }
6879  
6880  static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6881  ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6882  {
6883  	if (p2p) {
6884  		switch (type) {
6885  		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6886  			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6887  		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6888  			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6889  		default:
6890  			break;
6891  		}
6892  	}
6893  	return type;
6894  }
6895  
6896  static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6897  ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6898  {
6899  	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6900  }
6901  
6902  /**
6903   * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6904   * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6905   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6906   *
6907   * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6908   */
6909  static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6910  ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6911  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6912  {
6913  	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6914  }
6915  
6916  /**
6917   * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6918   * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6919   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6920   *
6921   * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6922   */
6923  static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6924  ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6925  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6926  {
6927  	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6928  }
6929  
6930  /**
6931   * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6932   * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6933   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6934   *
6935   * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6936   */
6937  static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6938  ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6939  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6940  {
6941  	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6942  }
6943  
6944  /**
6945   * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6946   *
6947   * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6948   * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6949   * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6950   * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6951   *
6952   * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6953   * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6954   * matching GroupId management frame.
6955   * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6956   */
6957  void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6958  				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6959  
6960  void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6961  				   int rssi_min_thold,
6962  				   int rssi_max_thold);
6963  
6964  void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6965  
6966  /**
6967   * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6968   *
6969   * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6970   *
6971   * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6972   *
6973   * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6974   * applicable.
6975   */
6976  int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6977  
6978  /**
6979   * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6980   * @vif: virtual interface
6981   * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6982   * @gfp: allocation flags
6983   *
6984   * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6985   */
6986  void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6987  				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6988  				    gfp_t gfp);
6989  
6990  /**
6991   * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6992   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6993   * @vif: virtual interface
6994   * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6995   * @band: the band to transmit on
6996   * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6997   *
6998   * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6999   */
7000  bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7001  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7002  			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7003  
7004  /**
7005   * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7006   *				 of injected frames.
7007   *
7008   * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7009   * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7010   * of the skb before calling this function.
7011   *
7012   * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7013   * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7014   */
7015  bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7016  				 struct net_device *dev);
7017  
7018  /**
7019   * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7020   *
7021   * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7022   * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7023   *
7024   * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7025   *
7026   * private:
7027   *
7028   * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7029   * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7030   */
7031  struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7032  	u32 next_tsf;
7033  	bool has_next_tsf;
7034  
7035  	u8 absent;
7036  
7037  	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7038  	struct {
7039  		u32 start;
7040  		u32 duration;
7041  		u32 interval;
7042  	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7043  };
7044  
7045  /**
7046   * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7047   *
7048   * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7049   * @data: NoA tracking data
7050   * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7051   *
7052   * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7053   */
7054  int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7055  			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7056  
7057  /**
7058   * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7059   *
7060   * @data: NoA tracking data
7061   * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7062   */
7063  void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7064  
7065  /**
7066   * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7067   * @vif: virtual interface
7068   * @peer: the peer's destination address
7069   * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7070   * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7071   * @gfp: allocation flags
7072   *
7073   * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7074   */
7075  void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7076  				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7077  				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7078  
7079  /**
7080   * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7081   *
7082   * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7083   * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7084   * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7085   * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7086   * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7087   * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7088   *
7089   * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7090   * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7091   * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7092   *
7093   * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7094   * @tid: the TID to reserve
7095   *
7096   * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7097   */
7098  int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7099  
7100  /**
7101   * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7102   *
7103   * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7104   * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7105   * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7106   *
7107   * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7108   * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7109   * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7110   *
7111   * @sta: the station
7112   * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7113   */
7114  void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7115  
7116  /**
7117   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7118   *
7119   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7120   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7121   *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7122   *
7123   * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7124   *
7125   * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7126   * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7127   * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7128   * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7129   * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7130   * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7131   * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7132   *
7133   * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7134   * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7135   */
7136  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7137  				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7138  
7139  /**
7140   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7141   * (in process context)
7142   *
7143   * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7144   * (internally disables bottom halves).
7145   *
7146   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7147   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7148   *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7149   */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7150  static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7151  						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7152  {
7153  	struct sk_buff *skb;
7154  
7155  	local_bh_disable();
7156  	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7157  	local_bh_enable();
7158  
7159  	return skb;
7160  }
7161  
7162  /**
7163   * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7164   *
7165   * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7166   * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7167   *
7168   * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7169   * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7170   */
7171  void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7172  				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7173  
7174  /**
7175   * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7176   *
7177   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7178   * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7179   *
7180   * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7181   * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7182   * driver has finished scheduling it.
7183   */
7184  struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7185  
7186  /**
7187   * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7188   *
7189   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7190   * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7191   *
7192   * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7193   * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7194   */
7195  void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7196  
7197  /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7198  static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7199  {
7200  }
7201  
7202  void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7203  			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7204  
7205  /**
7206   * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7207   *
7208   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7209   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7210   *
7211   * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7212   * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7213   *
7214   * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7215   * this TXQ internally.
7216   */
7217  static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7218  ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7219  {
7220  	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7221  }
7222  
7223  /**
7224   * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7225   *
7226   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7227   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7228   * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7229   *
7230   * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7231   * internally.
7232   */
7233  static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7234  ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7235  		     bool force)
7236  {
7237  	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7238  }
7239  
7240  /**
7241   * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7242   *
7243   * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7244   * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7245   * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7246   * next_txq().
7247   *
7248   * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7249   * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7250   * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7251   * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7252   * again.
7253   *
7254   * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7255   * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7256   * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7257   * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7258   * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7259   * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7260   *
7261   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7262   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7263   */
7264  bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7265  				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7266  
7267  /**
7268   * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7269   *
7270   * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7271   * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7272   * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7273   *
7274   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7275   * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7276   * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7277   */
7278  void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7279  			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7280  			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7281  
7282  /**
7283   * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7284   *
7285   * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7286   * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7287   *
7288   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7289   * @inst_id: the local instance id
7290   * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7291   * @gfp: allocation flags
7292   */
7293  void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7294  				   u8 inst_id,
7295  				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7296  				   gfp_t gfp);
7297  
7298  /**
7299   * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7300   *
7301   * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7302   * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7303   * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7304   *
7305   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7306   * @match: match event information
7307   * @gfp: allocation flags
7308   */
7309  void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7310  			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7311  			      gfp_t gfp);
7312  
7313  /**
7314   * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7315   *
7316   * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7317   * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7318   *
7319   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7320   * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7321   *          information.
7322   * @len: frame length in bytes
7323   */
7324  u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7325  			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7326  			      int len);
7327  
7328  /**
7329   * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7330   *
7331   * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7332   * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7333   *
7334   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7335   * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7336   * @len: frame length in bytes
7337   */
7338  u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7339  			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7340  			      int len);
7341  /**
7342   * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7343   *
7344   * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7345   * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7346   * hardware or firmware.
7347   *
7348   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7349   * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7350   */
7351  bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7352  
7353  /**
7354   * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7355   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7356   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7357   *
7358   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7359   *
7360   * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7361   */
7362  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7363  						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7364  
7365  /**
7366   * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7367   *	probe response template.
7368   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7369   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7370   *
7371   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7372   *
7373   * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7374   */
7375  struct sk_buff *
7376  ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7377  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7378  
7379  /**
7380   * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7381   * collision.
7382   *
7383   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7384   * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7385   *	aware of.
7386   * @gfp: allocation flags
7387   */
7388  void
7389  ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7390  				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7391  
7392  /**
7393   * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7394   *
7395   * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7396   * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7397   *
7398   * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7399   */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7400  static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7401  {
7402  	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7403  	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7404  
7405  	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7406  	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7407  }
7408  
7409  /**
7410   * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7411   * @vif: interface to set active links on
7412   * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7413   *
7414   * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7415   * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7416   * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7417   *
7418   * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7419   * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7420   * a sequence of calls like
7421   *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7422   *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7423   *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7424   *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7425   *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7426   *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7427   *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7428   *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7429   *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7430   *
7431   * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7432   *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7433   *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7434   */
7435  int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7436  
7437  /**
7438   * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7439   * @vif: interface to set active links on
7440   * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7441   *
7442   * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7443   * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7444   * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7445   * completed after it returns.
7446   */
7447  void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7448  				      u16 active_links);
7449  
7450  #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7451